jtag: drivers: xlnx-pcie-xvc: Add support for Xilinx XVC/PCIe
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * TFTP:: TFTP
83 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
84 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
85 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
86 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
87 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
88
89 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
90 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
91 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
92 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
93 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
94 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
95 @end menu
96
97 @node About
98 @unnumbered About
99 @cindex about
100
101 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
102 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
103 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
104 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
105 around the world.
106
107 @section What is OpenOCD?
108 @cindex TAP
109 @cindex JTAG
110
111 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
112 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
113 devices.
114
115 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
116 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
117 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
118 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
119 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
120 needed to hook up to the target.
121
122 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
123 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
124 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
125 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
126 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
127
128 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
129 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
130 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
131 let the development board connect directly to the debug
132 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
133
134 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
135 signaling, and is used to communicate
136 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
137 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
138 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
139 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
140 scan operations.
141
142 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
143 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
144 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
145 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
146
147 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
148 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
149 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
150 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
151
152
153 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
154 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
155 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
156
157 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
158 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
159 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
160 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
161
162 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
163 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
164 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
165 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
166 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
167
168 @section OpenOCD Web Site
169
170 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
171
172 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
173
174 @section Latest User's Guide:
175
176 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
177 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
178 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
179
180 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
181
182 PDF form is likewise published at:
183
184 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
185
186 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
187
188 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
189 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
190 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
191 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
192 instead of this forum.
193
194 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
195
196 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
197
198 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
199 communication between users:
200
201 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
202
203 @section OpenOCD IRC
204
205 Support can also be found on irc:
206 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
207
208 @node Developers
209 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
210 @cindex developers
211
212 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
213 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
214 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
215 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
216
217 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
218 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
219
220 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
221
222 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
223 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
224
225 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
226
227 or via http
228
229 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
230
231 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
232
233 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
234
235 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
236 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
237 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
238 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
239 needing a Git client:
240
241 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
242
243 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
244 from the repository or a snapshot.
245
246 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
247 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
248 Patches created against older versions may require additional
249 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
250
251 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
252
253 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
254 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
255 technical information about the software internals, development
256 processes, and similar documentation:
257
258 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
259
260 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
261 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
262 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
263
264 @section Gerrit Review System
265
266 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
267 Code Review System:
268
269 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
270
271 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
272 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
273 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
274 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
275 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
276
277 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
278 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
279 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
280 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
281 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
282
283 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
284
285 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
286 communication between developers:
287
288 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
289
290 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
291
292 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
293
294 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
295
296
297 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
299 @cindex dongles
300 @cindex FTDI
301 @cindex wiggler
302 @cindex zy1000
303 @cindex printer port
304 @cindex USB Adapter
305 @cindex RTCK
306
307 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
308 an adapter .... [snip]
309
310 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
311 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
312 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
313 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
314 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
315 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
316 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
317
318
319 @section Choosing a Dongle
320
321 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
322
323 @enumerate
324 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
325 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
326 other ways to communicate with target devices.
327 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
328 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
329 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
330 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
331 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
332 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
333 Ethernet port needed?
334 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
335 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
336 @end enumerate
337
338 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
339
340 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
341 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
342 running on the developer's host computer.
343 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
344 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
345 IP address assigned to the probe.
346 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
347 OpenOCD debugger.
348 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
349 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
350 the target.
351 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
352 to power cycle the target remotely.
353
354 For more information, visit:
355
356 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
357
358 @section USB FT2232 Based
359
360 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
361 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
362 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
363 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
364 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
365 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
366 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
367 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
368 clocking.)
369
370 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
371 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
372 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
373 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
374 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
375
376 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
377 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
378
379 @itemize @bullet
380 @item @b{usbjtag}
381 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
382 @item @b{jtagkey}
383 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
384 @item @b{jtagkey2}
385 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
386 @item @b{oocdlink}
387 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
388 @item @b{signalyzer}
389 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
390 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
391 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
392 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
393 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
394 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
395 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
396 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
397 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
398 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
399 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
400 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
401 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
402 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
403 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
404 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
405 @item @b{turtelizer2}
406 @* See:
407 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
408 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
409 @item @b{comstick}
410 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
411 @item @b{stm32stick}
412 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
413 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
414 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
415 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
416 @item @b{cortino}
417 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
418 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
419 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
420 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
421 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
422 @item @b{opendous}
423 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
424 (OpenHardware).
425 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
426 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
427
428 @item @b{GW16042}
429 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
430 FT2232H-based
431
432 @end itemize
433 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
434
435 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
436 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
437 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
438 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
439 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
440
441 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
442 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
443 (see the section on driver commands).
444
445 @itemize
446 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
447 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
448 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB J-Link based
453 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
454 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
455 AT91SAM764 internally.
456
457 @itemize @bullet
458 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
460 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
461 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
462 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
463 @end itemize
464
465 @section USB RLINK based
466 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
467 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
468 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
469
470 @itemize @bullet
471 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
472 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
473 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
474 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
475 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
476 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
477 @end itemize
478
479 @section USB ST-LINK based
480 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
481 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
482
483 @itemize @bullet
484 @item @b{ST-LINK}
485 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
486 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
487 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
488 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
489 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
490 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
491 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
492 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
493 @end itemize
494
495 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
496 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
497 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
498 @itemize @bullet
499 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
500 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
501 @end itemize
502
503 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
504 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
505 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
506 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
507
508 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
509 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
510 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
511
512 @section USB Other
513 @itemize @bullet
514 @item @b{USBprog}
515 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
516
517 @item @b{USB - Presto}
518 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
519
520 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
521 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
522
523 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
524 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
525
526 @item @b{Buspirate}
527 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
528
529 @item @b{opendous}
530 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
531
532 @item @b{estick}
533 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
534
535 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
536 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
537
538 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
539 @* The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
540 LaunchPad evaluation boards.
541 @* The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB debug probe. The XDS110
542 stand-alone probe has the additional ability to supply voltage to the target
543 board via its AUX FUNCTIONS port. Use the
544 @command{xds110_supply_voltage <millivolts>} command to set the voltage. 0 turns
545 off the supply. Otherwise, the supply can be set to any value in the range 1800
546 to 3600 millivolts.
547 @* Link: @url{http://processors.wiki.ti.com/index.php/XDS110}
548 @* Link: @url{http://processors.wiki.ti.com/index.php/XDS_Emulation_Software_Package#XDS110_Support_Utilities}
549 @end itemize
550
551 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
552
553 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
554 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
555 these on the market.
556
557 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
558 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
559 of USB-based ones.
560
561 @itemize @bullet
562
563 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
564 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
565
566 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
567 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
568 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
569
570 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
571 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
572
573 @item @b{Wiggler2}
574 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
575
576 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
577 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
578
579 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
580 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
581
582 @item @b{arm-jtag}
583 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
584
585 @item @b{chameleon}
586 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
587
588 @item @b{Triton}
589 @* Unknown.
590
591 @item @b{Lattice}
592 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
593 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
594
595 @item @b{flashlink}
596 @* From STMicroelectronics;
597 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
598
599 @end itemize
600
601 @section Other...
602 @itemize @bullet
603
604 @item @b{ep93xx}
605 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
606
607 @item @b{at91rm9200}
608 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
609
610 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
611 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
612
613 @item @b{imx_gpio}
614 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
615
616 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
617 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
618 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
619
620 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
621 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG interface.
622
623 @end itemize
624
625 @node About Jim-Tcl
626 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
627 @cindex Jim-Tcl
628 @cindex tcl
629
630 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
631 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
632 command interpreter.
633
634 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
635 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
636 much of anything about Tcl.
637 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
638
639 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
640 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
641 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
642 OpenOCD mailing list.
643
644 @itemize @bullet
645 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
646 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
647 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
648 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
649 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
650 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
651
652 @item @b{Missing Features}
653 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
654 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
655 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
656 enabled in OpenOCD.
657
658 @item @b{Scripts}
659 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
660 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
661 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
662
663 @item @b{Commands}
664 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
665 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
666 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
667 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
668
669 @item @b{Historical Note}
670 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
671 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
672 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
673 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
674
675 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
676 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
677 @end itemize
678
679 @node Running
680 @chapter Running
681 @cindex command line options
682 @cindex logfile
683 @cindex directory search
684
685 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
686 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
687 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
688 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
689 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
690 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
691 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
692
693 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
694 tell it how each debug session should work.
695 The @option{--help} option shows:
696 @verbatim
697 bash$ openocd --help
698
699 --help | -h display this help
700 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
701 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
702 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
703 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
704 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
705 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
706 --command | -c run <command>
707 @end verbatim
708
709 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
710 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
711 To specify one or more different
712 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
713
714 @example
715 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
716 @end example
717
718 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
719 @enumerate
720 @item the current directory,
721 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
722 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
723 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd} (not on Windows),
724 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
725 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
726 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
727 @end enumerate
728 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
729
730 @quotation Note
731 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
732 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
733 @end quotation
734
735 @section Simple setup, no customization
736
737 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
738 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
739 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
740 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
741 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
742
743 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
744 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
745 the server with some variation of one of the following:
746
747 @example
748 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
749 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
750 @end example
751
752 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
753 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
754 If all goes well you'll see output something like
755
756 @example
757 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
758 For bug reports, read
759 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
760 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
761 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
762 @end example
763
764 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
765 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
766 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
767
768 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
769
770 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
771 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
772 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
773 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
774 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
775 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
776 ensure that this always succeeds.
777 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
778 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
779 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
780 and then shut down without acting as a server.
781
782 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
783 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
784 those channels.
785
786 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
787 the @option{-d} option.
788
789 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
790 @option{-c} command line switch.
791
792 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
793 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
794 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
795 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
796 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
797 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
798 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
799
800 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
801 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
802
803 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
804 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
805 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
806 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
807
808 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
809 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
810
811 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
812 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
813 and start the OpenOCD server.
814 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
815 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
816 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
817 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
818
819 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
820
821 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
822 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
823 and a USB cable on the other.
824 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
825 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
826
827 @enumerate
828 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
829 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
830 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
831 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
832 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
833 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
834 debugging host.
835
836 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
837 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
838 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
839 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
840 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
841
842 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
843 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
844 with 1.2 Volt boards.
845
846 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
847 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
848 ways to connect the cable.
849 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
850 Be sure it's firmly connected.
851
852 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
853 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
854 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
855 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
856 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
857 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
858 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
859 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
860
861 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
862 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
863 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
864 but are tedious to set up.
865 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
866 adapter signals to the right board pins.
867
868 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
869 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
870 you are using to run OpenOCD.
871 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
872
873 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
874 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
875 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
876 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
877
878 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
879 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
880 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
881
882 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
883 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
884 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
885 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
886
887 @end enumerate
888
889 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
890 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
891 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
892
893 @section Project Directory
894
895 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
896
897 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
898 single directory for your work with a given board.
899 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
900 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
901 files accessed through semihosting,
902 and for code you upload to the target board.
903 It is also the natural place to write files,
904 such as log files and data you download from the board.
905
906 @section Configuration Basics
907
908 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
909 a variety of ways you can mix them.
910 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
911
912 @itemize
913 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
914 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
915 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
916 @end itemize
917
918 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
919 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
920 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
921
922 @example
923 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
924
925 # GDB can also flash my flash!
926 gdb_memory_map enable
927 gdb_flash_program enable
928
929 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
930 @end example
931
932 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
933
934 @example
935 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
936 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
937 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
938 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
939 @end example
940
941 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
942 each supporting a different development task.
943 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
944 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
945
946 @quotation Important
947 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
948 problems with how it treats variables.
949 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
950 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
951 that can be tested in a later script.
952 @end quotation
953
954 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
955 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
956 to simplify your work.
957
958 @section User Config Files
959 @cindex config file, user
960 @cindex user config file
961 @cindex config file, overview
962
963 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
964 in one place.
965 One of the following will match your situation best:
966
967 @itemize
968 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
969 provided by someone else.
970 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
971 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
972 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
973 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
974 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
975 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
976
977 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
978 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
979
980 @enumerate
981 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
982 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
983 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
984 @end enumerate
985
986 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
987 The first is an interface config file.
988 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
989 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
990 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
991 meet your deadline:
992
993 @example
994 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
995 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
996 @end example
997
998 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
999 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
1000 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
1001 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
1002
1003 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
1004 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
1005 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
1006 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
1007 target and board
1008 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
1009 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
1010
1011 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
1012 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1013 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1014 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1015
1016 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1017 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1018 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1019 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1020 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1021
1022 @quotation Note
1023 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1024 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1025 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1026 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1027 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1028 @end quotation
1029
1030 @item
1031 You may may need to write some C code.
1032 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1033 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1034 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1035 a new chip architecture.
1036 @end itemize
1037
1038 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1039 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1040 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1041
1042 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1043 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1044 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1045 @itemize
1046
1047 @item
1048 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1049 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1050 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1051 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1052
1053 @item
1054 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1055 @cindex vector_catch
1056 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1057 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1058 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1059 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1060 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1061 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1062
1063 @item
1064 You might need to override some defaults.
1065 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1066 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1067
1068 @item
1069 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1070 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1071 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1072 @end itemize
1073
1074 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1075
1076 A few project-specific utility
1077 routines may well speed up your work.
1078 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1079
1080 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1081 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1082 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1083 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1084 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1085 may help:
1086
1087 @example
1088 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1089 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1090 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1091 # Leave the CPU halted.
1092 reset init
1093
1094 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1095 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1096
1097 # Start running.
1098 resume 0x20000000
1099 @}
1100 @end example
1101
1102 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1103 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1104 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1105 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1106 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1107
1108 @example
1109 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1110 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1111 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1112 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1113 reset init
1114
1115 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1116 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1117 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1118 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1119 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1120 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1121 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1122
1123 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1124 reset run
1125 @}
1126 @end example
1127
1128 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1129 from NAND.
1130 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1131 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1132 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1133
1134 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1135 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1136
1137 @section Target Software Changes
1138
1139 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1140 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1141 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1142 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1143 handling issues like:
1144
1145 @itemize @bullet
1146
1147 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1148 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1149 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1150 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1151 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1152 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1153 your debug sessions.
1154
1155 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1156 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1157 That might however be your only option.
1158
1159 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1160 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1161 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1162 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1163 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1164 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1165 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1166 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1167 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1168 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1169 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1170 instead of the whole thing.
1171 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1172 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1173
1174 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1175 @cindex ARM semihosting
1176 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1177 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1178 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1179 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1180 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1181 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1182 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1183 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1184 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1185 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1186 NAND or SPI flash.
1187
1188 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1189 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1190 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1191 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1192 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1193
1194 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1195 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1196 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1197 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1198 registers which can be used to change various features including
1199 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1200 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1201 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1202 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1203 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1204
1205 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1206 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1207 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1208 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1209 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1210
1211 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1212 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1213 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1214 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1215 early code execution can be debugged
1216 or firmware can be replaced.
1217
1218 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1219 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1220 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1221 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1222 operations like writing to memory.)
1223
1224 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1225 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1226 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1227 various kinds of message.
1228 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1229
1230 @end itemize
1231
1232 @section Target Hardware Setup
1233
1234 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1235 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1236 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1237 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1238 working with.}
1239
1240 Common issues include:
1241
1242 @itemize @bullet
1243
1244 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1245 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1246 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1247 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1248 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1249 or one from a daughtercard).
1250 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1251 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1252
1253 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1254 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1255 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1256 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1257 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1258 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1259
1260 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1261 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1262 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1263 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1264 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1265
1266
1267 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1268 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1269 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1270 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1271 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1272 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1273 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1274
1275 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1276 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1277 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1278 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1279 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1280
1281 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1282 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1283 used to start booting.
1284
1285 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1286 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1287 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1288 multiple audio codec chips).
1289 This interacts with software
1290 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1291 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1292 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1293 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1294 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1295 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1296 audio or video codecs are used.
1297
1298 @end itemize
1299
1300 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1301 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1302 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1303 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1304 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1305 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1306 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1307 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1308 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1309 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1310
1311
1312 @node Config File Guidelines
1313 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1314
1315 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1316 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1317 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1318 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1319
1320 You should find the following directories under
1321 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1322 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1323 @itemize @bullet
1324 @item @file{interface} ...
1325 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1326 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1327 @item @file{board} ...
1328 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1329 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1330
1331 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1332 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1333 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1334 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1335 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1336 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1337 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1338 a CPU and an FPGA.
1339 @item @file{target} ...
1340 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1341 on a chip
1342 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1343 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1344 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1345 the target config file defines all of them.
1346 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1347 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1348 @end itemize
1349
1350 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1351 file may override features in any of the above files by
1352 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1353 commands specific to their situation.
1354
1355 @section Interface Config Files
1356
1357 The user config file
1358 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1359
1360 @example
1361 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1362 @end example
1363
1364 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1365 in use today with OpenOCD.
1366 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1367 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1368
1369 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1370 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1371 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1372 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1373 and need to provide a driver for it.
1374
1375 @section Board Config Files
1376 @cindex config file, board
1377 @cindex board config file
1378
1379 The user config file
1380 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1381
1382 @example
1383 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1384 @end example
1385
1386 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1387 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1388 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1389
1390 @enumerate
1391 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1392 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1393 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1394 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1395 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1396 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1397 @end enumerate
1398
1399 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1400 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1401 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1402 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1403
1404 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1405 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1406 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1407 configuration works.
1408
1409 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1410
1411 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1412 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1413 convention on how to use certain variables.
1414
1415 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1416 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1417 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1418 used at will within a target configuration file.
1419
1420 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1421 for a board with three chips:
1422
1423 @example
1424 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1425 set CHIPNAME network
1426 set ENDIAN big
1427 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1428 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1429 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1430 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1431
1432 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1433 set CHIPNAME video
1434 set ENDIAN little
1435 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1436 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1437 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1438 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1439
1440 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1441 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1442 unset ENDIAN
1443 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1444 @end example
1445
1446 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1447 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1448 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1449 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1450 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1451 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1452 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1453 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1454
1455 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1456 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1457 naming collisions.
1458
1459 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1460 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1461 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1462 up other clocks and peripherals.
1463
1464 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1465 @cindex variable names
1466
1467 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1468 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1469 one such chip (as shown above).
1470 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1471 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1472 to promote consistency and
1473 so that board files can override target defaults.
1474
1475 Inputs to target config files include:
1476
1477 @itemize @bullet
1478 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1479 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1480 tap identifier dotted names.
1481 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1482 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1483 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1484 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1485 Chips that can't change endianess don't need to use this variable.
1486 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1487 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1488 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1489 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1490 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1491 @end itemize
1492
1493 Outputs from target config files include:
1494
1495 @itemize @bullet
1496 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1497 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1498 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1499 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1500 specific to that board and that target.
1501 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1502 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1503 @end itemize
1504
1505 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1506 @cindex event, reset-init
1507 @cindex reset-init handler
1508
1509 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1510 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1511 fully set up yet.
1512 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1513 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1514 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1515 handler is one of the most important.
1516
1517 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1518 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1519 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1520 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1521 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1522
1523 @quotation Note
1524 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1525 are included here.
1526 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1527 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1528 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1529 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1530 @end quotation
1531
1532 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1533 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1534 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1535 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1536 those as parameters.
1537 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1538 and disabling the watchdog.
1539 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1540 the next developer doing such work.
1541 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1542
1543 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1544 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1545 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1546 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1547
1548 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1549
1550 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1551 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1552 a low JTAG clock rate.
1553 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1554 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1555 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1556 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1557 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1558 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1559 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1560
1561 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1562 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1563 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1564 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1565 which might be less than that.
1566
1567 @quotation Warning
1568 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1569 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1570 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1571 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1572 @end quotation
1573
1574 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1575 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1576 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1577 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter_khz}.
1578 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1579 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1580
1581 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1582 @subsection The init_board procedure
1583 @cindex init_board procedure
1584
1585 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1586 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1587 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1588 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1589 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1590 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1591 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1592 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1593 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1594 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1595 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1596 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1597
1598 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1599 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1600
1601 @example
1602 ### board_file.cfg ###
1603
1604 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1605 source [find target/target.cfg]
1606
1607 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1608 # enables fast on-board clock source
1609 # configures the chip to use it
1610 @}
1611
1612 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1613 proc init_board @{@} @{
1614 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1615
1616 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1617 adapter_khz 100
1618 @}
1619
1620 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1621 enable_fast_clock
1622 adapter_khz 10000
1623 @}
1624 @}
1625 @end example
1626
1627 @section Target Config Files
1628 @cindex config file, target
1629 @cindex target config file
1630
1631 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1632 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1633 more target config files like this:
1634
1635 @example
1636 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1637 @end example
1638
1639 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1640 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1641 In summary the target files should contain
1642
1643 @enumerate
1644 @item Set defaults
1645 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1646 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1647 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1648 @item On-Chip flash
1649 @end enumerate
1650
1651 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1652 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1653 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1654
1655 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1656 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1657 can talk to the chip.
1658 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1659 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1660 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1661 and other processing engines.
1662
1663 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1664
1665 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1666 letting board config files express environment-specific
1667 differences in how things should be set up.
1668
1669 @example
1670 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1671 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1672 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1673 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1674 @} else @{
1675 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1676 @}
1677
1678 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1679 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1680 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1681 @} else @{
1682 set _ENDIAN little
1683 @}
1684
1685 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1686 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1687 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1688 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1689 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1690 @} else @{
1691 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1692 @}
1693 @end example
1694 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1695
1696 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1697 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1698 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1699
1700 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1701 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1702 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1703
1704 @example
1705 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1706 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1707 @end example
1708
1709 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1710 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1711 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1712 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1713 for taps.
1714
1715 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1716 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1717 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1718 looks (in part) like this:
1719
1720 @example
1721 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1722 @end example
1723
1724 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1725 to source such a config file twice, with different
1726 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1727 it adds a different TAP each time.
1728
1729 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1730 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1731 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1732 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1733
1734 @example
1735 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1736 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1737 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1738 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1739 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1740 @end example
1741
1742 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1743 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1744
1745 @itemize
1746 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1747 plus a JRC to enable them
1748 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1749 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1750 is not currently used)
1751 @end itemize
1752
1753 @subsection Add CPU targets
1754
1755 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1756 GDB and other commands can use it.
1757 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1758 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1759 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1760 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1761
1762 @example
1763 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1764 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1765 @end example
1766
1767 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1768 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1769 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1770 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1771 a work area if you can.
1772 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1773
1774 @example
1775 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1776 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1777 @end example
1778
1779 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1780 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1781 @cindex SMP
1782 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1783
1784 @example
1785 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1786 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1787 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1788 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1789 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1790 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1791 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1792 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1793 @end example
1794 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1795 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1796 @itemize @bullet
1797 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1798 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1799 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1800 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1801 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1802 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1803 @end itemize
1804
1805 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1806 command have been implemented.
1807 @itemize @bullet
1808 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1809 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1810 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1811 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1812 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1813 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1814 following example.
1815 @end itemize
1816
1817 @example
1818 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1819 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1820 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1821 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1822 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1823 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1824 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1825 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1826 > resume
1827 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1828 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1829 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1830 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1831 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1832 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1833 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1834 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1835 @end example
1836
1837
1838 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1839
1840 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1841 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1842 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1843
1844 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1845 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1846 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1847 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1848 both signals.
1849
1850 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1851 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1852 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1853 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1854 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1855 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1856 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1857 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1858 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1859 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1860 not available.)
1861
1862 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1863 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1864 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1865 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1866 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1867 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1868 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1869 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1870
1871 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1872 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1873 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1874 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1875 slower clock than they will use later.
1876 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1877 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1878 than they will use later.
1879 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1880
1881 @quotation Important
1882 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1883 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1884 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1885 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1886 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1887 @end quotation
1888
1889 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1890 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1891 @cindex init_targets procedure
1892
1893 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1894 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1895 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1896 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1897 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1898 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1899 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1900 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1901 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1902
1903 @example
1904 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1905
1906 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1907 # basic initialization procedure ...
1908 @}
1909
1910 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1911 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1912 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1913 @}
1914
1915 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1916
1917 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1918
1919 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1920 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1921 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1922 @}
1923 @end example
1924
1925 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1926 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1927
1928 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1929
1930 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1931 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1932
1933 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1934 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1935 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1936
1937 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1938 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1939 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1940 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1941 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1942 events already assigned.
1943
1944 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1945
1946 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1947 special high speed download features - enable it.
1948
1949 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1950
1951 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1952 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1953 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1954 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1955 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1956 If you are using an external trace port,
1957 configure it in your board config file.
1958 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1959 configure it in your target config file.
1960
1961 @example
1962 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1963 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1964 @end example
1965
1966 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1967
1968 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1969
1970 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1971 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1972 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1973 the TARGET (chip) file.
1974
1975 Examples:
1976 @itemize @bullet
1977 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1978 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1979 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1980 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1981 @end itemize
1982
1983 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1984 @section Translating Configuration Files
1985 @cindex translation
1986 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1987 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1988 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1989 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1990 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1991 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1992
1993 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1994 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1995 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1996 convert other scripts later on.
1997
1998 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1999 replace job:
2000
2001 @example
2002 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
2003 #
2004 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
2005 #
2006 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
2007 #
2008 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
2009
2010 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
2011 global TARGETNAME
2012
2013 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2014
2015 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2016 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2017 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2018 @}
2019 @end example
2020
2021
2022
2023 @node Server Configuration
2024 @chapter Server Configuration
2025 @cindex initialization
2026 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2027 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2028 supported.
2029
2030 @anchor{configurationstage}
2031 @section Configuration Stage
2032 @cindex configuration stage
2033 @cindex config command
2034
2035 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2036 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2037 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2038 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2039 inside startup scripts.
2040
2041 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2042 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2043 which may be issued interactively.
2044 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2045 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2046
2047 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2048 flash banks,
2049 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2050 and other basic setup.
2051 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2052 may access or activate TAPs.
2053 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2054 longer be issued.
2055
2056 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2057 @section Entering the Run Stage
2058
2059 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2060 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2061 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2062 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2063 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2064 You should see no errors at this point.
2065 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2066 commands you used to configure the server.
2067 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2068 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2069 on the scan chain.
2070
2071 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2072 become available.
2073 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2074 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2075 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2076 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2077 entry to the run stage.
2078
2079 @deffn {Config Command} init
2080 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2081 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2082 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2083 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2084 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2085 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2086
2087 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2088 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2089 configuration files and/or command line options.
2090
2091 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2092 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2093 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2094 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2095 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2096 @end deffn
2097
2098 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2099 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2100 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2101
2102 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2103 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2104 scan chain.
2105 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2106 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2107
2108 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2109 they return.
2110 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2111 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2112 @end deffn
2113
2114 @anchor{tcpipports}
2115 @section TCP/IP Ports
2116 @cindex TCP port
2117 @cindex server
2118 @cindex port
2119 @cindex security
2120 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2121 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2122 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2123
2124 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2125 access using one or more of these ports.
2126 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2127 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2128 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2129
2130 @anchor{gdb_port}
2131 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2132 @cindex GDB server
2133 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2134 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2135 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2136 the normal use cases.
2137
2138 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2139 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2140 disables the gdb server.
2141
2142 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2143 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2144
2145 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2146 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2147
2148 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2149 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2150 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2151
2152 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2153 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2154 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2155 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2156 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2157 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2158 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2159 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2160 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2161
2162 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2163 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2164 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2165 @end deffn
2166
2167 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2168 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2169 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2170 output from the Tcl engine.
2171 Intended as a machine interface.
2172 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2173 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2174 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2175 @end deffn
2176
2177 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2178 Specify or query the
2179 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2180 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2181 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2182 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2183 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2184 @end deffn
2185
2186 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2187 @section GDB Configuration
2188 @cindex GDB
2189 @cindex GDB configuration
2190 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2191 The ones listed here are static and global.
2192 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2193 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2194
2195 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2196 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2197 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2198 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2199 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2200 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2201 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2202 @end deffn
2203
2204 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2205 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2206 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2207 vFlash packet is received.
2208 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2209 @end deffn
2210
2211 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2212 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2213 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2214 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2215 for flash programming to work.
2216 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2217 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2218 @end deffn
2219
2220 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2221 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2222 by GDB memory read packets.
2223 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2224 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2225 @end deffn
2226
2227 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_register_access_error (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2228 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2229 packets report errors or not.
2230 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2231 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2232 @end deffn
2233
2234 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2235 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2236 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2237 @end deffn
2238
2239 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2240 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2241
2242 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2243 @end deffn
2244
2245 @anchor{eventpolling}
2246 @section Event Polling
2247
2248 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2249 where significant events can happen at any time.
2250 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2251 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2252 or to GDB.
2253
2254 Examples of such events include:
2255
2256 @itemize
2257 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2258 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2259 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2260 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2261 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2262 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2263 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2264 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2265 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2266 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2267 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2268 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2269 @end itemize
2270
2271 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2272 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2273 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2274 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2275 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2276
2277 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2278 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2279 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2280 to the various active targets.
2281 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2282 which is normally done in the background.
2283
2284 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2285 Poll the current target for its current state.
2286 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2287 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2288 specific information about the current state is printed.
2289 An optional parameter
2290 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2291
2292 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2293 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2294 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2295 @example
2296 > poll
2297 background polling: on
2298 target state: halted
2299 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2300 current mode: Supervisor
2301 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2302 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2303 >
2304 @end example
2305 @end deffn
2306
2307 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2308 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2309 @cindex config file, interface
2310 @cindex interface config file
2311
2312 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2313 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2314 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2315
2316 @quotation Note
2317 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2318 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2319 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2320 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2321 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2322 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2323 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2324 @end quotation
2325
2326 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2327 through commands in an interface configuration
2328 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2329 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2330
2331 @example
2332 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2333 @end example
2334
2335 These commands tell
2336 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2337 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2338
2339 @example
2340 # jlink interface
2341 interface jlink
2342 @end example
2343
2344 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2345
2346
2347 @section Interface Configuration
2348
2349 The interface command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2350 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2351 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2352
2353 @deffn {Config Command} {interface} name
2354 Use the interface driver @var{name} to connect to the
2355 target.
2356 @end deffn
2357
2358 @deffn Command {interface_list}
2359 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2360 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2361 @end deffn
2362 @deffn Command {interface transports} transport_name+
2363 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2364 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2365 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2366 the hardware can support.
2367 @end deffn
2368
2369
2370
2371 @deffn Command {adapter_name}
2372 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2373 @end deffn
2374
2375 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2376 @deffn Command {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2377 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2378 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2379 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2380 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2381 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2382
2383 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2384 @end deffn
2385
2386 @section Interface Drivers
2387
2388 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2389 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2390 available at run time.
2391
2392 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2393 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2394 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2395 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2396
2397 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2398 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2399 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2400 @end deffn
2401
2402 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2403 Displays status of RTCK option.
2404 Optionally sets that option first.
2405 @end deffn
2406 @end deffn
2407
2408 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2409 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2410 This has one driver-specific command:
2411
2412 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2413 Logs some status
2414 @end deffn
2415 @end deffn
2416
2417 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2418 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2419 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2420 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2421 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2422 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2423 @end deffn
2424
2425 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2426 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
2427
2428 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2429 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2430 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2431 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2432 @example
2433 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2434 @end example
2435 @end deffn
2436
2437 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2438 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2439 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2440 @end deffn
2441
2442 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2443 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2444 @end deffn
2445 @end deffn
2446
2447 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2448 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2449 @end deffn
2450
2451 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2452 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2453 @end deffn
2454
2455 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2456 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2457 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2458
2459 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2460 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi or D2XX.
2461
2462 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2463 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2464
2465 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2466 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2467 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2468 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2469 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2470 @command{ftdi_get_signal} command.
2471
2472 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2473 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2474 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2475 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2476 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2477
2478 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2479 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2480 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2481 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2482
2483 @itemize @minus
2484 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2485 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2486 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2487 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2488 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2489 switching data and direction as necessary
2490 @end itemize
2491
2492 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2493 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2494
2495 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2496 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2497 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2498 @example
2499 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2500 @end example
2501 @end deffn
2502
2503 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2504 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2505 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2506 during device selection.
2507 @end deffn
2508
2509 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2510 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2511 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2512 is connected to the host.
2513 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2514 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2515 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2516 @end deffn
2517
2518 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_location} <bus>-<port>[.<port>]...
2519 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
2520 Use the command @ref{adapter_usb_location,,adapter usb location} instead.}
2521
2522 Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2523 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2524 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2525 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2526 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t}.
2527
2528 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2529 @end deffn
2530
2531 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2532 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2533 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2534 @end deffn
2535
2536 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2537 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2538 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2539 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2540 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2541 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2542 and initially asserted reset signals.
2543 @end deffn
2544
2545 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2546 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2547 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2548 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2549 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2550 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2551 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2552 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2553 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2554 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2555 with the method @command{ftdi_get_signal}.
2556
2557 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2558 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2559 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2560 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2561 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2562 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2563
2564 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2565 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2566 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2567 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2568 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2569 are always driven by the FTDI.
2570
2571 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2572 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2573 @var{name}.
2574 @end deffn
2575
2576 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2577 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2578 @itemize @minus
2579 @item @option{0}, drive low
2580 @item @option{1}, drive high
2581 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2582 @end itemize
2583 @end deffn
2584
2585 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_get_signal} name
2586 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2587 @end deffn
2588
2589 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2590 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2591
2592 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2593 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2594 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2595 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2596 @itemize @minus
2597 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2598 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2599 @end itemize
2600 @end deffn
2601
2602 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2603 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2604
2605 @end deffn
2606
2607 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2608 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2609 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2610 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2611
2612 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2613 @itemize @minus
2614 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2615 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2616 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2617 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2618 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2619 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2620 @end itemize
2621
2622 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2623 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2624 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2625 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2626 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2627 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2628 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2629 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2630
2631 FT232R
2632 @itemize @minus
2633 @item bit 7 - RI
2634 @item bit 6 - DCD
2635 @item bit 5 - DSR
2636 @item bit 4 - DTR
2637 @item bit 3 - CTS
2638 @item bit 2 - RTS
2639 @item bit 1 - RXD
2640 @item bit 0 - TXD
2641 @end itemize
2642
2643 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2644 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2645
2646 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2647 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2648 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2649 @end deffn
2650
2651 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_serial_desc} @var{serial}
2652 Specifies the @var{serial} of the adapter to use, in case the
2653 vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter is connected to
2654 the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2655 @end deffn
2656
2657 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2658 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2659 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2660 @end deffn
2661
2662 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tck_num} @var{tck}
2663 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2664 @end deffn
2665
2666 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tms_num} @var{tms}
2667 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2668 @end deffn
2669
2670 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2671 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2672 @end deffn
2673
2674 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2675 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2676 @end deffn
2677
2678 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_trst_num} @var{trst}
2679 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2680 @end deffn
2681
2682 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_srst_num} @var{srst}
2683 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2684 @end deffn
2685
2686 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_restore_serial} @var{word}
2687 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2688 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2689 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2690 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2691 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2692 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2693 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2694 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2695 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2696 @end deffn
2697
2698 @end deffn
2699
2700 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2701 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2702 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2703 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2704
2705 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2706 processors which are being simulated.
2707
2708 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2709 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2710 sockets instead of TCP.
2711 @end deffn
2712
2713 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2714 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2715 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2716 @end deffn
2717
2718 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2719 something like:
2720
2721 @example
2722 interface remote_bitbang
2723 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2724 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2725 @end example
2726
2727 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2728 named mysocket:
2729
2730 @example
2731 interface remote_bitbang
2732 remote_bitbang_port 0
2733 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2734 @end example
2735 @end deffn
2736
2737 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2738 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2739 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2740 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2741
2742 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2743 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2744 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2745 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2746 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2747 @end deffn
2748
2749 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2750 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2751 default values are used.
2752 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2753 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2754 @example
2755 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2756 @end example
2757 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2758 @example
2759 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2760 @end example
2761 @end deffn
2762
2763 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2764 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2765 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2766 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2767 target board.
2768
2769 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2770 @example
2771 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2772 reset_config srst_only
2773 @end example
2774 @end deffn
2775
2776 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2777 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2778 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2779 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2780 @end deffn
2781
2782 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2783 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2784 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2785 @end deffn
2786
2787 @end deffn
2788
2789 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2790 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2791 This has one driver-specific command:
2792
2793 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2794 Display either the address of the I/O port
2795 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2796 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2797 This is a write-once setting.
2798 @end deffn
2799 @end deffn
2800
2801 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2802 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2803 transports.
2804
2805 @quotation Compatibility Note
2806 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2807 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2808 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2809 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2810 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2811 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2812 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2813 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2814 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2815 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2816 @end quotation
2817
2818 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2819 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2820 states.
2821 @end deffn
2822 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2823 Display free device internal memory.
2824 @end deffn
2825 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2826 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2827 command version.
2828 @end deffn
2829 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2830 Display the device configuration.
2831 @end deffn
2832 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2833 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2834 power state.
2835 @end deffn
2836 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2837 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2838 @end deffn
2839 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2840 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2841 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2842 IP configuration.
2843 @end deffn
2844 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2845 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2846 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2847 @end deffn
2848 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2849 Reset the current configuration.
2850 @end deffn
2851 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2852 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2853 @end deffn
2854 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write <channel> <data>}
2855 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2856 pairs.
2857
2858 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2859 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2860 @example
2861 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2862 @end example
2863 @end deffn
2864 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read <channel> <length>}
2865 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2866 pairs.
2867
2868 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2869 @example
2870 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2871 77a90000
2872 @end example
2873 @end deffn
2874 @deffn {Config} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2875 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2876 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2877 selection via USB address is deprecated and the serial number should be used
2878 instead.
2879
2880 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2881 @end deffn
2882 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2883 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2884 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2885
2886 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2887 @end deffn
2888 @end deffn
2889
2890 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2891 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2892 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2893 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2894 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2895 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2896 configuration script.
2897
2898 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2899 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2900 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2901 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2902 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2903
2904 Known limitations:
2905 @itemize @bullet
2906 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2907 and 2.7 MHz.
2908 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2909 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2910 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2911 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2912 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2913 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2914 communications with the target.
2915 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2916 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2917 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2918 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2919 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2920 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2921 @end itemize
2922
2923 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2924 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2925 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2926 @end deffn
2927
2928 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
2929 Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
2930 device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
2931 @end deffn
2932
2933 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2934 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2935 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2936 target as a side-effect.
2937 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2938 @end deffn
2939
2940 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2941 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2942 version, and target voltage.
2943 @end deffn
2944 @end deffn
2945
2946 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2947 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2948 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2949 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2950 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2951
2952 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2953 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2954 This is a write-once setting.
2955 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2956
2957 @itemize @minus
2958 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2959 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2960 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2961 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2962 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2963 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2964 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2965 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2966 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2967 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2968 some versions of
2969 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2970 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2971 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2972 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2973 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2974 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2975 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2976 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2977 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2978 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2979 @end itemize
2980 @end deffn
2981
2982 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2983 Display either the address of the I/O port
2984 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2985 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2986 This is a write-once setting.
2987
2988 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2989 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2990 you may encounter a problem.
2991 @end deffn
2992
2993 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2994 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2995 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2996 @command{adapter_khz} configuration.
2997 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2998 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2999
3000 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
3001 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
3002 @quotation Tip
3003 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
3004 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
3005 @example
3006 > parport_toggling_time 1000
3007 > adapter_khz 500
3008 @end example
3009 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
3010 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
3011 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
3012 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
3013 large set of samples.
3014 Update the setting to match your measurement:
3015 @example
3016 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
3017 @end example
3018 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter_khz rate}
3019 commands given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3020
3021 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3022 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3023 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3024 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3025 match for the adapter_khz rate you specified; be conservative.
3026 @end quotation
3027 @end deffn
3028
3029 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3030 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3031 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3032 @end deffn
3033
3034 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3035 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3036
3037 @example
3038 interface parport
3039 parport_port 0x278
3040 parport_cable wiggler
3041 @end example
3042 @end deffn
3043
3044 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3045 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3046 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
3047 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
3048 @end deffn
3049 @end deffn
3050
3051 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3052 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3053 @end deffn
3054
3055 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3056 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3057 @end deffn
3058
3059 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3060 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3061
3062 @quotation Note
3063 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3064 which are not currently documented here.
3065 @end quotation
3066 @end deffn
3067
3068 @anchor{hla_interface}
3069 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3070 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3071 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3072 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3073
3074 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK and TI ICDI.
3075 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3076 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3077 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3078 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3079
3080 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3081 Currently Not Supported.
3082 @end deffn
3083
3084 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
3085 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3086 @end deffn
3087
3088 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi})
3089 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3090 @end deffn
3091
3092 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3093 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3094 @end deffn
3095
3096 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3097 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3098 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3099 @end deffn
3100 @end deffn
3101
3102 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3103 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3104 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3105 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3106 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3107
3108 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3109 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3110 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3111 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3112
3113 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3114 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3115
3116 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link serial} serial
3117 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3118 @end deffn
3119
3120 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3121 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3122 @end deffn
3123 @end deffn
3124
3125 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3126 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3127 @end deffn
3128
3129 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3130 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3131 @end deffn
3132
3133 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3134 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3135 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3136 fabric based JTAG devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3137 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3138
3139 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3140
3141 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc_config} device
3142 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3143
3144 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3145 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3146
3147 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3148
3149 @end deffn
3150 @end deffn
3151
3152 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
3153 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
3154 @end deffn
3155
3156 @quotation Note
3157 This defines some driver-specific commands,
3158 which are not currently documented here.
3159 @end quotation
3160
3161 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
3162 Turn power switch to target on/off.
3163 No arguments: print status.
3164 @end deffn
3165
3166 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3167 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3168 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3169
3170 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3171 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3172 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3173 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3174 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3175 configuration on exit.
3176
3177 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3178 pinout.
3179
3180 @end deffn
3181
3182 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3183 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3184 of the one which is most popular.
3185
3186 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3187
3188 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3189 pinout.
3190
3191 @end deffn
3192
3193
3194 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3195 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3196 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3197
3198 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_variant} variant
3199 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3200 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3201
3202 @itemize @minus
3203 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3204 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3205 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3206 @end itemize
3207 @end deffn
3208
3209 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_device_desc} string
3210 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3211 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3212 @end deffn
3213 @end deffn
3214
3215 @section Transport Configuration
3216 @cindex Transport
3217 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3218 and the debug adapter you are using,
3219 several transports may be available to
3220 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3221 @deffn Command {transport list}
3222 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3223 version of OpenOCD.
3224 @end deffn
3225
3226 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3227 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3228
3229 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3230 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3231 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3232 adapter's driver).
3233
3234 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3235 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3236 supported by the debug adapter.
3237
3238 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3239 transport, if any.
3240 @end deffn
3241
3242 @subsection JTAG Transport
3243 @cindex JTAG
3244 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3245 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3246 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3247 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3248 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3249 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3250
3251 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3252 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3253 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3254 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3255 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3256
3257 @subsection SWD Transport
3258 @cindex SWD
3259 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3260 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3261 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3262 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3263 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3264 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3265 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3266
3267 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3268 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3269 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3270 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3271 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3272
3273 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3274 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3275 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3276 expected to change.
3277 @end deffn
3278 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3279 Updates TRN (turnaround delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3280 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3281 No parameters: displays current settings.
3282 @end deffn
3283
3284 @subsection SPI Transport
3285 @cindex SPI
3286 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3287 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3288 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3289 solution for flash programming.
3290
3291 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3292 @section JTAG Speed
3293 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3294 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3295 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3296 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3297 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3298 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3299 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3300 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3301 power management software that may be active.
3302
3303 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3304 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3305 target event handler.
3306 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3307 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3308 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3309 sets up those clocks).
3310 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3311 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3312 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3313 in the target config file.
3314 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3315 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3316 config file instead.
3317 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3318 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3319 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3320
3321 @example
3322 jtag_rclk 3000
3323 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3324 @end example
3325
3326 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3327 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3328 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3329 may not be the fastest solution.
3330
3331 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3332 instead of @command{adapter_khz}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3333 which support adaptive clocking.
3334
3335 @deffn {Command} adapter_khz max_speed_kHz
3336 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3337 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3338 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3339 than the speed specified.
3340
3341 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3342 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3343 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3344 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3345
3346 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3347 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3348 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3349 JTAG clocking after setup.
3350 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3351 If the interface device can not
3352 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3353 @end deffn
3354
3355 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3356 @cindex adaptive clocking
3357 @cindex RTCK
3358 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3359 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3360 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3361 @example
3362 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3363 jtag_rclk 3000
3364 @end example
3365 @end defun
3366
3367 @node Reset Configuration
3368 @chapter Reset Configuration
3369 @cindex Reset Configuration
3370
3371 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3372 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3373 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3374 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3375 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3376 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3377 Please see the various board files for examples.
3378
3379 @quotation Note
3380 To maintainers and integrators:
3381 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3382 Normally the board configuration file
3383 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3384 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3385
3386 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3387 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3388 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3389 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3390 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3391 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3392 @end quotation
3393
3394 @section Types of Reset
3395
3396 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3397 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3398 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3399
3400 @itemize @bullet
3401 @item
3402 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3403 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3404 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3405 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3406 @item
3407 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3408 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3409 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3410 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3411 @item
3412 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3413 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3414 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3415 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3416 @item
3417 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3418 several other types of reset.
3419 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3420 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3421 There may be individual module resets.
3422 @end itemize
3423
3424 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3425 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3426 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3427 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3428 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3429 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3430 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3431 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3432 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3433
3434 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3435 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3436
3437 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3438 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3439 common issues are:
3440
3441 @itemize @bullet
3442
3443 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3444 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3445 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3446 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3447 when either of those signals is not connected.
3448 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3449 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3450 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3451 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3452
3453 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3454 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3455 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3456 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3457
3458 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3459 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3460 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3461 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3462 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3463 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3464 hardware debouncing.
3465 Use the @command{adapter_nsrst_delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3466 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3467
3468 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3469 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3470 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3471 to use push/pull output drivers.
3472 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3473 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3474 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3475 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3476
3477 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3478 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3479 issues (not limited to errata).
3480 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3481 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3482 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3483 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3484 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3485 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3486 @end itemize
3487
3488 There can also be other issues.
3489 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3490 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3491 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3492 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3493 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3494 Agreement (NDA).
3495
3496 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3497 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3498 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3499
3500 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3501 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3502
3503 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3504
3505 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_assert_width milliseconds
3506 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3507 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3508 allowing it to be deasserted.
3509 @end deffn
3510
3511 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_delay milliseconds
3512 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3513 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3514 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3515 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3516 @end deffn
3517
3518 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3519 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3520 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3521 allowing it to be deasserted.
3522 @end deffn
3523
3524 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3525 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3526 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3527 @end deffn
3528
3529 @anchor{reset_config}
3530 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3531 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3532 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3533 configuration scripts.
3534
3535 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3536 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3537 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3538 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3539 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3540 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3541 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3542 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3543
3544 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3545 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3546 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3547 -- may be specified at a time.
3548 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3549 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3550 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3551 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3552 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3553
3554 @itemize
3555 @item
3556 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3557 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3558 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3559 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3560 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3561
3562 @quotation Tip
3563 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3564 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3565 @end quotation
3566
3567 @item
3568 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3569 signal implementations.
3570 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3571 indicating everything behaves normally.
3572 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3573 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3574 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3575 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3576 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3577 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3578 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3579
3580 @item
3581 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3582 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3583 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3584 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3585 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3586 while SRST is asserted.
3587 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3588 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3589
3590 @item
3591 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3592 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3593 is required to use this option.
3594 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3595 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3596 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3597 be asserted before any target connection.
3598 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3599 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3600 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3601 @end itemize
3602
3603 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3604 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3605 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3606 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3607 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3608
3609 @itemize
3610 @item
3611 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3612 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3613 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3614 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3615
3616 @item
3617 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3618 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3619 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3620 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3621 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3622 @end itemize
3623 @end deffn
3624
3625 @section Custom Reset Handling
3626 @cindex events
3627
3628 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3629 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3630 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3631 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3632 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3633 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3634
3635 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3636 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3637 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3638 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3639 want to reset everything at once.
3640
3641 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3642 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3643 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3644 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3645 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3646 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3647 needs special attention.
3648
3649 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
3650 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
3651 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3652 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3653 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3654 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3655 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3656 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3657 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3658
3659 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3660 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3661 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3662 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3663 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3664
3665 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3666 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3667 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3668 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3669 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3670 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3671 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3672 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3673 or potentially some other value.
3674
3675 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3676 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3677 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
3678 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3679 (or their associated targets)
3680 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3681
3682 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3683 they return.
3684 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3685 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3686 @end deffn
3687
3688 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3689 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3690 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3691 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3692 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3693 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3694 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3695 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3696 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3697 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3698 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3699 @end deffn
3700
3701 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3702 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3703 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3704 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3705 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3706 @end deffn
3707
3708
3709 @node TAP Declaration
3710 @chapter TAP Declaration
3711 @cindex TAP declaration
3712 @cindex TAP configuration
3713
3714 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3715 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3716
3717 @itemize @bullet
3718 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3719 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3720 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3721 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3722 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3723 start running that code.
3724 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3725 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3726 and missing connections.
3727 @end itemize
3728
3729 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3730 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3731 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3732 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3733 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3734
3735 @section Scan Chains
3736 @cindex scan chain
3737
3738 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3739 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3740 They also need to be added to
3741 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3742 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3743 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3744 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3745 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3746 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3747 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3748 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3749
3750 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3751 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3752 command, presented in the next chapter.
3753 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3754 debugging targets.)
3755 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3756
3757 @verbatim
3758 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3759 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3760 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3761 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3762 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3763 @end verbatim
3764
3765 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3766 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3767 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3768 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3769 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3770 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3771 until they are told to do so.
3772
3773 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3774 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3775 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3776 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3777
3778 @example
3779 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3780 @end example
3781
3782 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3783 by a given chip.
3784 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3785 and so forth.
3786 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3787 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3788 both inside a single chip and between them.
3789 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3790
3791 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
3792 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3793 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3794 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3795 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3796 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3797 includes commands something like this:
3798
3799 @example
3800 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3801 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3802 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3803 @end example
3804
3805 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3806 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3807 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3808
3809 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3810 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3811 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3812 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3813 @example
3814 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3815 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3816 @}
3817 @end example
3818 @end deffn
3819
3820 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3821 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3822 and their status.
3823 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3824 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3825 but systems with a JTAG router can
3826 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3827 @end deffn
3828
3829 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3830 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3831
3832 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3833 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3834
3835 @section TAP Names
3836 @cindex dotted name
3837
3838 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3839 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3840 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3841 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3842 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3843 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3844 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3845 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3846
3847 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3848 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3849 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3850
3851 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3852
3853 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3854 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3855 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3856 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3857
3858 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3859 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3860 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3861 overridable.
3862
3863 @cindex TAP naming convention
3864 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3865 and should follow this convention:
3866
3867 @itemize @bullet
3868 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3869 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3870 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3871 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3872 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3873 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3874 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3875 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3876 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3877 with a single TAP;
3878 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3879 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3880 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3881 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3882 @end itemize
3883
3884 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3885
3886 @itemize @bullet
3887 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3888 @*The length in bits of the
3889 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3890 @end itemize
3891
3892 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3893
3894 @itemize @bullet
3895 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3896 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3897 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3898 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3899 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3900 (the TAP is linked in).
3901 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3902 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3903 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3904 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3905 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3906 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3907 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3908 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3909 values that were found but not included in the list.
3910
3911 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3912 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3913 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3914 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3915 hardware to find these values.
3916 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3917 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3918 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3919 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3920 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3921 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3922 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3923 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3924 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3925 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3926 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3927 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3928 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3929 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3930 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
3931 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
3932 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
3933 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
3934 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
3935 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
3936 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
3937 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
3938 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
3939 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
3940 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
3941 @end itemize
3942 @end deffn
3943
3944 @section Other TAP commands
3945
3946 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
3947 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
3948 @end deffn
3949
3950 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
3951 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
3952 At this writing this TAP attribute
3953 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
3954 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
3955 mechanism for debugger targets.)
3956 See the next section for information about the available events.
3957
3958 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
3959 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
3960 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
3961 @end deffn
3962
3963 @section TAP Events
3964 @cindex events
3965 @cindex TAP events
3966
3967 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
3968 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
3969 The other applies to debugger targets,
3970 which are associated with certain TAPs.
3971
3972 The TAP events currently defined are:
3973
3974 @itemize @bullet
3975 @item @b{post-reset}
3976 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
3977 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
3978 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
3979 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
3980 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
3981
3982 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
3983 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
3984 of any particular target.
3985 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
3986 @item @b{setup}
3987 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
3988 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
3989 @item @b{tap-disable}
3990 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
3991 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
3992 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3993 @item @b{tap-enable}
3994 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
3995 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
3996 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3997 @end itemize
3998
3999 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4000 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4001 contents to be accurate), you might:
4002
4003 @example
4004 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4005 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4006 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4007 @}
4008 @end example
4009
4010
4011 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4012 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4013 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4014 @cindex jrc
4015
4016 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4017 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4018 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4019 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4020 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4021
4022 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4023 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4024 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4025 be visible.
4026 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4027 ignores, such as:
4028
4029 @itemize
4030 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4031 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4032 TAPs receive new instructions.
4033 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4034 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4035 @end itemize
4036
4037 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4038 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4039 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4040 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4041
4042 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4043 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4044
4045 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4046 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4047 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4048 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4049 should define TAP event handlers using
4050 code that looks something like this:
4051
4052 @example
4053 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4054 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4055 @}
4056 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4057 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4058 @}
4059 @end example
4060
4061 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4062
4063 @example
4064 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4065 @end example
4066
4067 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4068 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4069 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4070 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4071
4072 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4073 If necessary, disables the tap
4074 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4075 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4076 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4077 and "0" if it is disabled.
4078 @end deffn
4079
4080 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4081 If necessary, enables the tap
4082 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4083 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4084 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4085 and "0" if it is disabled.
4086 @end deffn
4087
4088 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4089 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4090 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4091 and "0" if it is disabled.
4092
4093 @quotation Note
4094 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4095 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4096 @end quotation
4097 @end deffn
4098
4099 @anchor{autoprobing}
4100 @section Autoprobing
4101 @cindex autoprobe
4102 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4103
4104 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4105 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4106 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4107 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4108
4109 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4110 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4111 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4112 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4113 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4114 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4115 right when they come out of reset).
4116
4117 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4118
4119 @example
4120 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4121 reset_config trst_and_srst
4122 jtag_rclk 8
4123 @end example
4124
4125 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4126 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4127
4128 @enumerate
4129 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4130 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4131 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4132 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4133 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4134 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4135 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4136 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4137 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4138 that is discovered.
4139 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4140 register, it will report it.
4141 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4142 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4143 @end enumerate
4144
4145 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4146 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4147 that's a bit more complex:
4148
4149 @example
4150 clock speed 8 kHz
4151 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4152 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4153 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4154 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4155 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4156 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4157 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4158 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4159 @end example
4160
4161 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4162 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4163 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4164 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4165 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4166 and so forth.
4167
4168 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4169 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4170 @cindex DAP declaration
4171
4172 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4173 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4174 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4175 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4176 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4177
4178 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4179
4180 @deffn Command {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4181 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4182 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4183 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4184 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4185
4186 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4187
4188 @itemize @bullet
4189 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4190 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4191 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4192 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4193 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4194 @end itemize
4195 @end deffn
4196
4197 @deffn Command {dap names}
4198 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4199 for TCL scripting.
4200 @end deffn
4201
4202 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
4203 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4204 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4205 @end deffn
4206
4207 @deffn Command {dap init}
4208 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4209 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4210 initialization, too.
4211 @end deffn
4212
4213 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4214
4215 @deffn Command {$dap_name info} [num]
4216 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4217 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4218 @end deffn
4219
4220 @deffn Command {$dap_name apid} [num]
4221 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4222 @end deffn
4223
4224 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4225 @deffn Command {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4226 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4227 or set a new value @var{value}.
4228 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4229 @end deffn
4230
4231 @deffn Command {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4232 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4233 @end deffn
4234
4235 @deffn Command {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4236 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4237 value @var{value}.
4238
4239 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4240 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4241 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4242
4243 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4244 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4245 @end deffn
4246
4247 @deffn Command {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4248 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4249 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4250 @end deffn
4251
4252 @deffn Command {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4253 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4254 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4255 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4256 @end deffn
4257
4258 @deffn Command {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4259 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4260
4261 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4262 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4263 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4264 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4265 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4266 for details.
4267
4268 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4269 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4270 the pattern:
4271 @example
4272 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4273 @end example
4274
4275 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4276 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4277 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4278 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4279 @example
4280 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4281 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4282 @end example
4283
4284 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4285 @example
4286 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4287 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4288 @end example
4289
4290 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4291 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4292
4293 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4294 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4295 example with a proper dap name:
4296 @example
4297 xxx.dap apcsw default
4298 @end example
4299 @end deffn
4300
4301 @deffn Command {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4302 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4303 Disabled by default
4304 @end deffn
4305
4306
4307 @node CPU Configuration
4308 @chapter CPU Configuration
4309 @cindex GDB target
4310
4311 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4312 You can also access these targets without GDB
4313 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4314 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4315 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4316 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4317
4318 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4319 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4320
4321 @section Target List
4322 @cindex target, current
4323 @cindex target, list
4324
4325 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4326 where each member has a name.
4327 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4328 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4329 (plural!) command.
4330 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4331 look like with more than one:
4332 @verbatim
4333 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4334 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4335 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4336 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4337 @end verbatim
4338
4339 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4340 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4341 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4342 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4343 space seen by that current target.
4344 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4345 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4346 are examples; and there are many more.
4347
4348 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4349
4350 @deffn Command {target current}
4351 Returns the name of the current target.
4352 @end deffn
4353
4354 @deffn Command {target names}
4355 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4356 @example
4357 foreach t [target names] @{
4358 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4359 @}
4360 @end example
4361 @end deffn
4362
4363 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4364 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4365
4366 @deffn Command targets [name]
4367 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4368 command names are singular.}
4369
4370 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4371 targets in a user friendly form.
4372
4373 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4374 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4375 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4376 @end deffn
4377
4378 @section Target CPU Types
4379 @cindex target type
4380 @cindex CPU type
4381
4382 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4383 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4384 when calling @command{target create}.
4385 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4386 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4387 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4388 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4389 what core-specific commands may be available
4390 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4391 and more.
4392
4393 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4394 since there's a command to list them.
4395
4396 @anchor{targettypes}
4397 @deffn Command {target types}
4398 Lists all supported target types.
4399 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4400
4401 @itemize @bullet
4402 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores
4403 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4404 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4405 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4406 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU
4407 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core
4408 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4409 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4410 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4411 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7 core with an MMU
4412 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7 core, supporting only the
4413 compact Thumb2 instruction set.
4414 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU
4415 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e
4416 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4417 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4418 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4419 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4420 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb)
4421 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926
4422 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of support for new CPUs.
4423 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core
4424 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4425 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4426 @item @code{openrisc} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4427 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4428 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4429 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4430 @itemize @minus
4431 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4432 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4433 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4434 @end itemize
4435 And two debug interfaces cores:
4436 @itemize @minus
4437 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4438 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4439 @end itemize
4440 @end itemize
4441 @end deffn
4442
4443 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4444 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4445 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4446 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4447 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4448 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4449 reflect design generations;
4450 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4451 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4452
4453 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4454 @section Target Configuration
4455
4456 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4457 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4458 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4459 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4460 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4461
4462 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4463 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4464 optional parts.
4465 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4466 command, created as part of target creation.
4467
4468 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4469 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4470 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4471 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4472 to be much more board-specific.
4473 The key steps you use might look something like this
4474
4475 @example
4476 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4477 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4478 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4479 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4480 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4481 @end example
4482
4483 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4484 on-chip SRAM.
4485 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4486 writes to target memory;
4487 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4488 GDB memory checksumming;
4489 and more.
4490
4491 @quotation Warning
4492 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4493 inaccessible when application code
4494 (such as an operating system)
4495 enables or disables the MMU.
4496 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4497 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4498 easy access to other addresses needed.
4499 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4500 @end quotation
4501
4502 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4503 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4504 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4505 controllers.
4506 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4507 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4508 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4509
4510 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4511 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4512 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4513 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4514 purposes including additional configuration.
4515
4516 @itemize @bullet
4517 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4518 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4519 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4520 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4521
4522 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4523 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4524 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4525 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4526 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4527 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4528 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4529
4530 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4531 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4532 @end itemize
4533 @end deffn
4534
4535 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4536 The options accepted by this command may also be
4537 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4538 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4539 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4540
4541 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4542 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4543 and changing its endianness.
4544
4545 @itemize @bullet
4546
4547 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4548 used to access this target.
4549
4550 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4551 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4552 create and manage DAP instances.
4553
4554 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4555 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4556
4557 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4558 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4559 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4560 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4561 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4562 same event name assigns only one handler.
4563
4564 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4565 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4566
4567 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4568 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4569 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4570 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4571 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4572 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4573 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4574
4575 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4576 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4577 or virtual address is being used.
4578
4579 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4580 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4581
4582 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4583 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4584 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4585 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4586 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4587
4588 @anchor{rtostype}
4589 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4590 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4591 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4592 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx}
4593 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4594
4595 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4596 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4597 access the target for debugging.
4598
4599 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4600 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4601 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4602 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4603
4604 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4605 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4606 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4607 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4608 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4609
4610 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4611 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4612 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4613 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4614 command @command{gdb_port}.
4615 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4616 @end itemize
4617 @end deffn
4618
4619 @section Other $target_name Commands
4620 @cindex object command
4621
4622 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4623 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4624
4625 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4626 Once a button is created a button
4627 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4628 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4629 configure it like this:
4630
4631 @example
4632 # Create
4633 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4634 # Modify
4635 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4636 # Query
4637 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4638 # Report
4639 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4640 @end example
4641
4642 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4643 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4644
4645 @example
4646 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4647 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4648 @end example
4649
4650 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4651
4652 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4653 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4654 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4655 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4656 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4657 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4658 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4659 They are not otherwise documented here.
4660 @end deffn
4661
4662 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4663 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4664 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4665 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4666 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4667 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4668 the target side uses raw memory.
4669
4670 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4671 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4672 The script orientation comes from working with data
4673 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4674 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4675 and neither store nor return those values.
4676
4677 @itemize
4678 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4679 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4680 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4681 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4682 @end itemize
4683 @end deffn
4684
4685 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4686 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4687 @command{$target_name configure}
4688 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4689 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4690 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4691 There are a few special cases:
4692
4693 @itemize @bullet
4694 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4695 event named @var{event_name}.
4696 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4697 two parameters.
4698 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4699 This is a special case because this is set using
4700 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4701 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4702 @end itemize
4703
4704 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4705 all the targets you might use something like this:
4706
4707 @example
4708 foreach name [target names] @{
4709 set y [$name cget -endian]
4710 set z [$name cget -type]
4711 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4712 $x $name $y $z]
4713 @}
4714 @end example
4715 @end deffn
4716
4717 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4718 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4719 Displays the current target state:
4720 @code{debug-running},
4721 @code{halted},
4722 @code{reset},
4723 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4724 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4725 @end deffn
4726
4727 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4728 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4729 currently associated with this target.
4730 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4731 @end deffn
4732
4733 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4734 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4735 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4736 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4737 @end deffn
4738
4739 @deffn Command {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
4740 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
4741 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
4742 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
4743 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4744 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
4745 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4746 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4747 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4748 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4749 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4750 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4751 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4752 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4753 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4754 @end deffn
4755
4756 @deffn Command {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
4757 @deffnx Command {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
4758 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
4759 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
4760 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
4761 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
4762 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4763 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4764 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4765 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4766 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4767 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
4768 @end deffn
4769
4770 @anchor{targetevents}
4771 @section Target Events
4772 @cindex target events
4773 @cindex events
4774 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4775 For example:
4776 @itemize @bullet
4777 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4778 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4779 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4780 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4781 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4782 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4783 to set up system clocks or
4784 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4785 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4786 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4787 @end itemize
4788
4789 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4790 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4791 @command{target create ... -event}.
4792
4793 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4794 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4795 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4796
4797 @example
4798 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
4799 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4800 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4801 @}
4802 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
4803 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
4804 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4805 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4806 @}
4807 @end example
4808
4809 The following target events are defined:
4810
4811 @itemize @bullet
4812 @item @b{debug-halted}
4813 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4814 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4815 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
4816 @item @b{early-halted}
4817 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4818 @item @b{examine-start}
4819 @* Before target examine is called.
4820 @item @b{examine-end}
4821 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4822 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4823 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
4824 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
4825 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
4826 connect GDB to running target.
4827 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
4828 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
4829 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
4830 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
4831 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
4832 is in RAM or read only memory.
4833 Default is @code{halt}
4834 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4835 @* When GDB disconnects
4836 @item @b{gdb-end}
4837 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4838 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4839 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4840 @code{reset init})
4841 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4842 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4843 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4844 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4845 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4846 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4847 @item @b{gdb-start}
4848 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
4849 @item @b{halted}
4850 @* The target has halted
4851 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4852 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4853 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
4854 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
4855 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4856 @item @b{reset-assert}
4857 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4858 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4859 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4860 it instead of asserting SRST.
4861 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4862 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4863 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4864 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4865 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4866 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4867 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4868 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4869 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4870 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4871 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4872 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4873 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4874 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4875 released on the scan chain.
4876 @item @b{reset-end}
4877 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4878 @item @b{reset-init}
4879 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4880 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4881
4882 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4883 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4884 multiplexing, and so on.
4885 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4886 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4887 @item @b{reset-start}
4888 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
4889 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
4890
4891 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4892 or @command{adapter_khz} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4893 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4894 @item @b{resume-start}
4895 @* Before any target is resumed
4896 @item @b{resume-end}
4897 @* After all targets have resumed
4898 @item @b{resumed}
4899 @* Target has resumed
4900 @item @b{trace-config}
4901 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
4902 @end itemize
4903
4904 @node Flash Commands
4905 @chapter Flash Commands
4906
4907 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
4908 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
4909 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
4910 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
4911 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
4912 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
4913 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
4914 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
4915 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
4916
4917 Flash Steps:
4918 @enumerate
4919 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
4920 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
4921 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
4922 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
4923 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
4924 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
4925 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
4926 @item GDB Flashing
4927 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
4928 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
4929 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
4930 @end enumerate
4931
4932 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
4933 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
4934 so that it can't boot.
4935 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
4936 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
4937
4938 @anchor{norconfiguration}
4939 @section Flash Configuration Commands
4940 @cindex flash configuration
4941
4942 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
4943 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
4944 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
4945 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
4946 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
4947 see the driver-specific documentation.
4948
4949 @itemize @bullet
4950 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
4951 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
4952 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
4953 associated with the flash bank being declared.
4954 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
4955 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
4956 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
4957 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
4958 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
4959 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
4960 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
4961 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4962 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
4963 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4964 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
4965 commands to the flash controller.
4966 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
4967 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
4968 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
4969 for more information.
4970 @end itemize
4971 @quotation Note
4972 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
4973 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
4974 @end quotation
4975 @end deffn
4976
4977 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
4978 @deffn Command {flash banks}
4979 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
4980 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4981 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
4982 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
4983 @end deffn
4984
4985 @deffn Command {flash list}
4986 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
4987 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4988 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
4989 @end deffn
4990
4991 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
4992 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
4993 depends on the flash type.
4994 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4995 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
4996 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
4997 but most don't bother.
4998 @end deffn
4999
5000 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5001
5002 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5003 begins.
5004
5005 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5006 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5007 until the programming session is finished.
5008
5009 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5010 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5011
5012 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5013
5014 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5015 @cindex flash erasing
5016 @cindex flash reading
5017 @cindex flash writing
5018 @cindex flash programming
5019 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5020
5021 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5022 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5023 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5024 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5025 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5026
5027 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5028 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5029 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5030 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5031 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5032
5033 @quotation Note
5034 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5035 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5036 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5037 back to a flash bank.
5038 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5039 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5040 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5041 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5042 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5043 @end quotation
5044
5045 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5046 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5047 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5048 disabled first.
5049 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5050 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5051 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5052
5053 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
5054 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5055 up to and including @var{last}.
5056 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5057 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5058 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5059 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5060 @end deffn
5061
5062 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5063 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5064 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5065 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5066 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5067 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5068 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5069 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5070 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5071 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5072 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5073 before erase starts.
5074 @end deffn
5075
5076 @deffn Command {flash fillw} address word length
5077 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
5078 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
5079 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
5080 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5081 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5082 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5083 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5084 before issuing this command.
5085 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5086 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5087 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5088 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5089 @end deffn
5090 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5091
5092 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5093 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5094 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5095 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5096 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5097 @end deffn
5098
5099 @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5100 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5101 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5102 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5103 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5104 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5105 @end deffn
5106
5107 @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5108 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5109 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5110 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5111 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5112 @end deffn
5113
5114 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5115 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5116 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5117 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5118 to the base address for each section in the image.
5119 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5120 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5121 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5122 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5123 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5124 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5125 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5126 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5127 each image section.
5128
5129 @quotation Warning
5130 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5131 data you want to preserve.
5132 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5133 sections might be erased with no notice.
5134 @itemize
5135 @item
5136 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5137 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5138 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5139 @item
5140 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5141 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5142 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5143 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5144 @end itemize
5145 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5146 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5147 @end quotation
5148
5149 @end deffn
5150
5151 @section Other Flash commands
5152 @cindex flash protection
5153
5154 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
5155 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5156 and display that status.
5157 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5158 @end deffn
5159
5160 @deffn Command {flash info} num [sectors]
5161 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5162 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5163
5164 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5165 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5166 and possibly stale information.
5167 @end deffn
5168
5169 @anchor{flashprotect}
5170 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5171 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5172 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5173 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5174 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5175 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5176 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5177 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5178 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5179 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5180 @end deffn
5181
5182 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
5183 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5184 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5185 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5186 @end deffn
5187
5188 @anchor{program}
5189 @deffn Command {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5190 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5191 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5192 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5193 @end deffn
5194
5195 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5196 @section Flash Driver List
5197 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5198 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5199 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5200
5201 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
5202 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5203 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5204
5205 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5206
5207 @itemize
5208 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5209 @end itemize
5210
5211 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5212 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5213 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5214 @example
5215 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5216 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5217 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5218 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5219 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5220 @end example
5221 @end deffn
5222
5223 @subsection External Flash
5224
5225 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
5226 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5227 @cindex CFI
5228 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5229 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5230 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5231 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5232 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5233 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5234 configure a bus and its timings), or
5235 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5236 on the flash chip.
5237 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5238 speed up operation.
5239
5240 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5241
5242 @itemize
5243 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5244 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5245 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5246 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5247 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5248 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5249 @end itemize
5250
5251 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5252 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5253
5254 @example
5255 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5256 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5257 @end example
5258
5259 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5260 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5261 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5262
5263 @example
5264 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5265 @end example
5266
5267 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5268 @end deffn
5269
5270 @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
5271 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5272 @cindex SPI
5273 @cindex jtagspi
5274 @cindex bscan_spi
5275 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5276 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5277 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5278 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5279 accessed through JTAG.
5280
5281 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5282 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5283 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5284 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5285 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5286 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5287
5288 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5289 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5290 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5291 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5292 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5293 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5294 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5295 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5296
5297 @itemize
5298 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5299 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5300 @var{USER1} instruction.
5301 @end itemize
5302
5303 @example
5304 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5305 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5306 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5307 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5308 @end example
5309 @end deffn
5310
5311 @deffn {Flash Driver} xcf
5312 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5313 @cindex xcf
5314 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5315 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5316 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5317 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5318 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5319
5320 @deffn Command {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5321 command accepts additional parameters:
5322 @itemize
5323 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5324 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5325 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5326 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5327 in master mode.
5328 @end itemize
5329 @example
5330 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5331 @end example
5332 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5333 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5334 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5335 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5336 dedicated sector.
5337 @end deffn
5338
5339 @deffn Command {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5340 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5341 button.
5342 @example
5343 xcf configure 0
5344 @end example
5345 @end deffn
5346
5347 Additional driver notes:
5348 @itemize
5349 @item Only single revision supported.
5350 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5351 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5352 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5353 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5354 @end itemize
5355 @end deffn
5356
5357 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
5358 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5359 @cindex SPIFI
5360 @cindex lpcspifi
5361 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5362 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5363 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5364
5365 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5366 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5367 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5368 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5369 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5370
5371 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5372 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5373 are configured by the driver.
5374
5375 @example
5376 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5377 @end example
5378
5379 @end deffn
5380
5381 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
5382 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5383 @cindex SMI
5384 @cindex stmsmi
5385 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5386 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5387 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5388 SPI flash devices.
5389 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5390 flash devices can be connected.
5391
5392 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5393 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5394 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5395 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5396 the flash content.
5397
5398 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5399 to identify the memory bank.
5400 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5401 flash size, are detected automatically.
5402
5403 @example
5404 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5405 @end example
5406
5407 @end deffn
5408
5409 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
5410 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5411 Microcontroller platform.
5412
5413 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5414 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5415
5416 @example
5417 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5418 @end example
5419
5420 @end deffn
5421
5422 @deffn {Flash Driver} ath79
5423 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5424 @cindex ath79
5425 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5426 chip selects.
5427 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5428 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5429 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5430 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5431 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5432 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5433
5434 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5435 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5436 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5437 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5438 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5439 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5440 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5441 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5442 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5443 with the default CS0.
5444 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5445 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5446 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5447
5448 @example
5449 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5450
5451 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different for each,
5452 # otherwise the write_image command is not able to distinguish the
5453 # banks.
5454 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5455 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5456 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5457 @end example
5458
5459 @end deffn
5460
5461 @deffn {Flash Driver} fespi
5462 @cindex Freedom E SPI
5463 @cindex fespi
5464
5465 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
5466
5467 @example
5468 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5469 @end example
5470 @end deffn
5471
5472 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5473
5474 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
5475 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5476 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5477 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5478 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5479 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5480
5481 @example
5482 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5483 @end example
5484 @end deffn
5485
5486 @deffn {Flash Driver} ambiqmicro
5487 @cindex ambiqmicro
5488 @cindex apollo
5489 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5490 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5491 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5492 with the target using SWD.
5493
5494 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5495 the device class of the MCU.
5496 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5497 to set up the flash banks.
5498 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5499 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5500
5501 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5502 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5503 and the second bank starts after the first.
5504
5505 @example
5506 # Flash bank 0
5507 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5508 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5509 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5510 $_TARGETNAME
5511 @end example
5512
5513 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5514 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5515 are available to the user.
5516
5517 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5518
5519 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5520 Erase entire bank.
5521 @end deffn
5522 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5523 Erase device pages.
5524 @end deffn
5525 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5526 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5527 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5528 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5529 the flash.
5530 @end deffn
5531 @end deffn
5532
5533 @anchor{at91samd}
5534 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
5535 @cindex at91samd
5536 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5537 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5538
5539 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
5540
5541 The devices have one flash bank:
5542
5543 @example
5544 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5545 @end example
5546
5547 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
5548 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5549 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5550 processor to be halted.
5551 @end deffn
5552
5553 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
5554 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5555 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5556 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5557 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5558 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5559
5560 @example
5561 at91samd set-security enable
5562 @end example
5563 @end deffn
5564
5565 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
5566 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5567 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5568 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5569 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5570 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
5571 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5572 in order to disable this feature.
5573
5574 @example
5575 at91samd eeprom
5576 at91samd eeprom 1024
5577 @end example
5578 @end deffn
5579
5580 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
5581 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5582 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5583 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5584 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5585 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5586
5587 @example
5588 at91samd bootloader
5589 at91samd bootloader 16384
5590 @end example
5591 @end deffn
5592
5593 @deffn Command {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5594 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5595 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5596 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5597 @end deffn
5598
5599 @deffn Command {at91samd nvmuserrow}
5600 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
5601 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
5602 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
5603 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5604 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
5605 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
5606 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
5607
5608 @example
5609 # Read user row
5610 >at91samd nvmuserrow
5611 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5612 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
5613 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5614 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low byte unchanged
5615 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
5616 @end example
5617 @end deffn
5618
5619 @end deffn
5620
5621 @anchor{at91sam3}
5622 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
5623 @cindex at91sam3
5624 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5625 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5626 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5627 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5628 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5629 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5630 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
5631 chips are confirmed.}
5632
5633 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5634 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5635 the following fixed locations:
5636
5637 @example
5638 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5639 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5640 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5641 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5642 @end example
5643
5644 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5645 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5646 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5647
5648 @itemize
5649 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5650 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5651 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5652 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5653 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5654 @end itemize
5655
5656 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5657
5658 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5659 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5660 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5661 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5662 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5663 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5664 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5665
5666 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5667 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5668 @end deffn
5669
5670 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5671 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5672 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5673 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5674 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5675 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5676 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5677 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5678 @end deffn
5679
5680 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5681 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5682 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5683 @end deffn
5684 @end deffn
5685
5686 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5687 @cindex at91sam4
5688 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5689 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5690 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5691 @end deffn
5692
5693 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
5694 @cindex at91sam4l
5695 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5696 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5697 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5698
5699 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5700 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5701 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5702 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5703 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5704 @end deffn
5705 @end deffn
5706
5707 @anchor{atsame5}
5708 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsame5
5709 @cindex atsame5
5710 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
5711 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
5712 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5713
5714 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
5715 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
5716 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
5717
5718 @example
5719 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5720 @end example
5721
5722 @deffn Command {atsame5 bootloader}
5723 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
5724 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5725 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
5726 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
5727 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5728
5729 @example
5730 atsame5 bootloader
5731 atsame5 bootloader 16384
5732 @end example
5733 @end deffn
5734
5735 @deffn Command {atsame5 chip-erase}
5736 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5737 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5738 processor to be halted.
5739 @end deffn
5740
5741 @deffn Command {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
5742 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5743 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5744 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5745 @end deffn
5746
5747 @deffn Command {atsame5 userpage}
5748 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
5749 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
5750 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
5751 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5752 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
5753 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
5754 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
5755
5756 @example
5757 # Read
5758 >atsame5 userpage
5759 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
5760 # Write
5761 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
5762 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other bits unchanged
5763 # (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192 bytes)
5764 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
5765 @end example
5766 @end deffn
5767
5768 @end deffn
5769
5770 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsamv
5771 @cindex atsamv
5772 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
5773 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
5774 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5775 @end deffn
5776
5777 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
5778 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
5779 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
5780 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
5781 register, and autoconfigures itself.
5782
5783 @example
5784 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5785 @end example
5786
5787 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
5788 provide additional parameters in the following order:
5789
5790 @itemize
5791 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
5792 @item @var{banks}
5793 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
5794 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
5795 @item @var{pages_size}
5796 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
5797 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
5798 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
5799 @end itemize
5800
5801 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
5802 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
5803 will be autoconfigured.
5804 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
5805
5806 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
5807 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
5808 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
5809 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
5810 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
5811
5812 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
5813 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
5814 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
5815 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
5816 are not truly general purpose).
5817 @quotation Note
5818 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
5819 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
5820 @end quotation
5821 @end deffn
5822 @end deffn
5823
5824 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
5825 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
5826 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
5827 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5828 @end deffn
5829
5830 @deffn {Flash Driver} bluenrg-x
5831 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1 and BlueNRG-2 Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0 core and internal flash memory.
5832 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
5833 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
5834
5835 @example
5836 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5837 @end example
5838
5839 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
5840 each single sector one by one.
5841
5842 @example
5843 flash erase_sector 0 0 79 # It will perform a mass erase on BlueNRG-1
5844 @end example
5845
5846 @example
5847 flash erase_sector 0 0 127 # It will perform a mass erase on BlueNRG-2
5848 @end example
5849
5850 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
5851 @end deffn
5852
5853 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc26xx
5854 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
5855 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
5856 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
5857 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
5858 starts at address 0.
5859
5860 @example
5861 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5862 @end example
5863 @end deffn
5864
5865 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc3220sf
5866 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
5867 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
5868 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
5869 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
5870 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
5871 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
5872 and programming the serial flash.
5873
5874 @example
5875 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5876 @end example
5877 @end deffn
5878
5879 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
5880 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
5881 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
5882 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
5883 autoconfigures itself.
5884 @example
5885 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5886 @end example
5887 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
5888 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
5889 this via the following command:
5890 @example
5891 efm32 debuglock num
5892 @end example
5893 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5894 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
5895 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
5896 supported.}
5897 @end deffn
5898
5899 @deffn {Flash Driver} esirisc
5900 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
5901 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
5902 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
5903 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
5904 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
5905
5906 @example
5907 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
5908 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
5909 @end example
5910
5911 @deffn Command {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
5912 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
5913 @end deffn
5914
5915 @deffn Command {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
5916 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
5917 is an uncommon operation.}
5918 @end deffn
5919 @end deffn
5920
5921 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
5922 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
5923 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
5924 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
5925 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5926 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
5927 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
5928
5929 @example
5930 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5931 @end example
5932 @end deffn
5933
5934 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm4
5935 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
5936 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
5937 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
5938 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5939 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
5940 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
5941 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
5942 characters) ignored.
5943
5944 @example
5945 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
5946 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5947 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
5948 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5949 @end example
5950 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
5951 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
5952 @end deffn
5953
5954 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis
5955 @cindex kinetis
5956 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
5957 from NXP (former Freescale) include
5958 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
5959 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
5960 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5961 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
5962
5963 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
5964 @itemize
5965 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
5966 @end itemize
5967
5968 @example
5969 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5970 @end example
5971
5972 @deffn Command {kinetis create_banks}
5973 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
5974 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
5975 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
5976 @end deffn
5977
5978 @deffn Command {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
5979 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
5980 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
5981 set by 'flash protect' command.
5982 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
5983 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
5984 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
5985 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
5986 with the rest of a flash image.
5987 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
5988 @end deffn
5989
5990 @deffn Command {kinetis fopt} [num]
5991 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
5992 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
5993 @end deffn
5994
5995 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm check_security}
5996 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5997 @end deffn
5998
5999 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm halt}
6000 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6001 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6002 @end deffn
6003
6004 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6005 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6006 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6007 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6008 command completes.
6009 @end deffn
6010
6011 @deffn Command {kinetis nvm_partition}
6012 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6013 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6014 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6015 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6016
6017 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6018 Program Partition command.
6019
6020 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6021 Reset the device after partition setting.
6022
6023 Show partition size:
6024 @example
6025 kinetis nvm_partition info
6026 @end example
6027
6028 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6029 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6030 @example
6031 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6032 @end example
6033
6034 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6035 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6036 @example
6037 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6038 @end example
6039 @end deffn
6040
6041 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm reset}
6042 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6043 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6044 @end deffn
6045
6046 @deffn Command {kinetis disable_wdog}
6047 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6048 Command disables watchdog timer.
6049 @end deffn
6050 @end deffn
6051
6052 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis_ke
6053 @cindex kinetis_ke
6054 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6055 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6056 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6057 autoconfigures itself.
6058 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6059
6060 @example
6061 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6062 @end example
6063
6064 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6065 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6066 @end deffn
6067
6068 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6069 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6070 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6071 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6072 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6073 @end deffn
6074
6075 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6076 Command disables watchdog timer.
6077 @end deffn
6078 @end deffn
6079
6080 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
6081 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6082 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6083 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6084 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6085
6086 @quotation Note
6087 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6088 driver:
6089 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6090 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6091 @end quotation
6092
6093 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6094 which must appear in the following order:
6095
6096 @itemize
6097 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6098 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6099 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6100 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6101 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6102 LPC43x[2357])
6103 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6104 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6105 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6106 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6107 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6108 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6109 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6110 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6111 at which the core is running
6112 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6113 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6114 @quotation Note
6115 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6116 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6117 However, if you do provide it,
6118 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6119 @end quotation
6120 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6121 ROM IAP entry point.
6122 @end itemize
6123
6124 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6125
6126 @example
6127 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6128 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6129 @end example
6130
6131 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6132 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6133 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6134 @end deffn
6135 @end deffn
6136
6137 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
6138 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6139 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6140 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6141 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6142 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6143
6144 @example
6145 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6146 @end example
6147 @end deffn
6148
6149 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
6150 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6151 from NXP.
6152
6153 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6154 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6155 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6156 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6157 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6158 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6159 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6160 you start the PLL.
6161
6162 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6163
6164 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6165 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6166 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6167
6168 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6169 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6170 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6171 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6172 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6173 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6174 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6175
6176 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6177 @example
6178 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6179 @end example
6180
6181 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6182 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6183 @code{flash banks} command.
6184
6185 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
6186 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6187 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6188 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6189 a known signature.
6190 Example:
6191 @example
6192 lpc2900 signature 0
6193 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6194 @end example
6195 @end deffn
6196
6197 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6198 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6199 saves it to a file in binary format.
6200 Example:
6201 @example
6202 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6203 @end example
6204 @end deffn
6205
6206 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6207 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6208 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6209 command:
6210
6211 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
6212 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6213 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6214 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6215
6216 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6217 Example:
6218 @example
6219 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6220 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6221 @end example
6222 @end deffn
6223
6224 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6225 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6226 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6227 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6228 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6229 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6230 912 bytes.
6231 @quotation Attention
6232 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6233 @end quotation
6234 Example:
6235 @example
6236 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6237 @end example
6238 @end deffn
6239
6240 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6241 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6242 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6243 after the next power cycle.
6244 @quotation Attention
6245 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6246 @end quotation
6247 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6248 Example:
6249 @example
6250 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6251 flash info 0
6252 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6253 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6254 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6255 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6256 @end example
6257 @end deffn
6258
6259 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6260 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6261 effective after the next power cycle.
6262 @quotation Attention
6263 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6264 @end quotation
6265 Examples:
6266 @example
6267 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6268 @end example
6269 @end deffn
6270 @end deffn
6271
6272 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
6273 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6274 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6275 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6276
6277 @example
6278 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6279 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6280 @end example
6281
6282 @itemize @bullet
6283 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6284 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6285 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6286 @end itemize
6287
6288 Example usage:
6289 @example
6290 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6291 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6292 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6293 @} else @{
6294 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6295 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6296 @}
6297 @end example
6298 @end deffn
6299
6300 @deffn {Flash Driver} msp432
6301 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6302 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6303 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6304 Main program flash (starting at address 0) is flash bank 0. Information flash
6305 region on MSP432P4 versions (starting at address 0x200000) is flash bank 1.
6306
6307 @example
6308 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6309 @end example
6310
6311 @deffn Command {msp432 mass_erase} [main|all]
6312 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6313 only the main program flash.
6314
6315 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6316 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6317 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6318 @end deffn
6319
6320 @deffn Command {msp432 bsl} [unlock|lock]
6321 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6322 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6323 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6324
6325 To erase and program the BSL:
6326 @example
6327 msp432 bsl unlock
6328 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6329 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6330 msp432 bsl lock
6331 @end example
6332 @end deffn
6333 @end deffn
6334
6335 @deffn {Flash Driver} niietcm4
6336 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6337 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6338 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6339 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6340 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6341 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6342 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6343 also have division into regions: main and info.
6344 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6345 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6346
6347 @example
6348 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6349 @end example
6350
6351 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6352
6353 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6354 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6355 @end deffn
6356
6357 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6358 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6359 @end deffn
6360
6361 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6362 Erase all userflash including info region.
6363 @end deffn
6364
6365 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6366 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6367 @end deffn
6368
6369 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6370 Check sectors protect.
6371 @end deffn
6372
6373 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6374 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6375 @end deffn
6376
6377 @deffn Command {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6378 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6379 @end deffn
6380
6381 @deffn Command {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6382 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6383 @end deffn
6384
6385 @deffn Command {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6386 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6387 @end deffn
6388
6389 @deffn Command {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6390 Show information about flash driver.
6391 @end deffn
6392
6393 @end deffn
6394
6395 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf5
6396 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6397 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
6398 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
6399 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
6400
6401 @example
6402 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6403 @end example
6404
6405 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6406
6407 @deffn Command {nrf5 mass_erase}
6408 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6409 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6410 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6411 code.
6412 @end deffn
6413
6414 @deffn Command {nrf5 info}
6415 Decodes and shows informations from FICR and UICR registers.
6416 @end deffn
6417
6418 @end deffn
6419
6420 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
6421 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6422 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6423
6424 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6425 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6426 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6427 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6428
6429 @example
6430 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6431 @end example
6432 @end deffn
6433
6434 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
6435 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6436 and integrate flash memory.
6437
6438 @example
6439 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6440 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6441 @end example
6442
6443 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6444 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6445 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6446 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6447 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6448 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6449 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6450 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6451 @end deffn
6452 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
6453 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6454 This will remove any Code Protection.
6455 @end deffn
6456 @end deffn
6457
6458 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
6459 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6460 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6461 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6462 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6463
6464 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6465 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6466
6467 @example
6468 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6469 @end example
6470
6471 psoc4-specific commands
6472 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6473 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6474
6475 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6476 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6477
6478 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6479 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6480 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6481
6482 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6483 @end deffn
6484
6485 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6486 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6487
6488 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6489 @end deffn
6490 @end deffn
6491
6492 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp
6493 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6494 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6495 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6496 apart from the base address.
6497
6498 @example
6499 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6500 @end example
6501
6502 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6503 @quotation Attention
6504 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6505 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6506 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6507 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6508 @end quotation
6509
6510 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6511
6512 @deffn Command {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6513 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6514 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6515 @end deffn
6516 @end deffn
6517
6518 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_eeprom
6519 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6520 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6521 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6522 apart from the base address.
6523
6524 @example
6525 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6526 @end example
6527 @end deffn
6528
6529 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_nvl
6530 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6531 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6532 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6533
6534 @example
6535 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6536 @end example
6537
6538 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
6539
6540 @itemize
6541 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
6542 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
6543 @end itemize
6544
6545 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
6546
6547 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
6548 @quotation Attention
6549 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
6550 after successful write.
6551 @end quotation
6552 @end deffn
6553
6554 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc6
6555 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
6556 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
6557 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
6558
6559 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
6560 @itemize @bullet
6561 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
6562 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
6563 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
6564 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
6565 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
6566 row size: 512 bytes.
6567 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
6568 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
6569 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
6570 operation will erase row automatically.
6571 @end itemize
6572
6573 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
6574 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
6575
6576 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
6577
6578 @example
6579 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6580 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6581 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6582 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6583 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6584 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6585
6586 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6587 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6588 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6589 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6590 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6591 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6592 @end example
6593
6594 psoc6-specific commands
6595 @deffn Command {psoc6 reset_halt}
6596 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
6597 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
6598 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
6599 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
6600 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
6601 @end deffn
6602
6603 @deffn Command {psoc6 mass_erase} num
6604 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
6605 by @command{flash banks}.
6606 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
6607 @end deffn
6608 @end deffn
6609
6610 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
6611 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
6612 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
6613 and SWD interface.
6614 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
6615 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
6616
6617 @example
6618 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6619 @end example
6620
6621 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
6622
6623 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
6624 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
6625 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
6626 @end deffn
6627
6628 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
6629 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
6630 @end deffn
6631 @end deffn
6632
6633 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
6634 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
6635 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
6636 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
6637 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6638
6639 @example
6640 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6641 @end example
6642
6643 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
6644 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
6645 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
6646 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
6647 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
6648 disabled.
6649
6650 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
6651 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
6652 @quotation Warning
6653 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
6654 applied to all of them.
6655 @end quotation
6656 @end deffn
6657 @end deffn
6658
6659 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
6660 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
6661 from STMicroelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
6662 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6663 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6664
6665 @example
6666 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6667 @end example
6668
6669 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6670 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6671 the flash driver.
6672
6673 @example
6674 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6675 @end example
6676
6677 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
6678 as per the following example.
6679 @example
6680 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6681 @end example
6682
6683 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
6684
6685 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
6686 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
6687 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6688 @end deffn
6689
6690 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
6691 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
6692 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
6693 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6694 @end deffn
6695
6696 @deffn Command {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
6697 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
6698 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6699 @end deffn
6700
6701 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
6702 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
6703 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
6704 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6705 @end deffn
6706
6707 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
6708 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
6709 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6710 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
6711 @end deffn
6712
6713 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_load} num
6714 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
6715 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
6716 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
6717 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6718 @end deffn
6719 @end deffn
6720
6721 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
6722 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6723 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
6724 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6725 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6726
6727 @example
6728 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6729 @end example
6730
6731 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
6732 as per the following example.
6733 @example
6734 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6735 @end example
6736
6737 @deffn Command {stm32f2x otp } num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
6738 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
6739 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6740 @end deffn
6741
6742 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6743 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6744 the flash driver.
6745
6746 @example
6747 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6748 @end example
6749
6750 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
6751
6752 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
6753 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6754 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6755 @end deffn
6756
6757 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
6758 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6759 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6760 @end deffn
6761
6762 @deffn Command {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
6763 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
6764 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6765 @end deffn
6766
6767 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_read} num
6768 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
6769 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6770 @end deffn
6771
6772 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
6773 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
6774 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
6775 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
6776 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
6777 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
6778 @end deffn
6779
6780 @deffn Command {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
6781 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
6782 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
6783 @end deffn
6784 @end deffn
6785
6786 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32h7x
6787 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6788 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
6789 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6790 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6791
6792 @example
6793 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6794 @end example
6795
6796 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6797 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6798 the flash driver.
6799
6800 @example
6801 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6802 @end example
6803
6804 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
6805
6806 @deffn Command {stm32h7x lock} num
6807 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6808 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6809 @end deffn
6810
6811 @deffn Command {stm32h7x unlock} num
6812 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6813 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6814 @end deffn
6815
6816 @deffn Command {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
6817 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
6818 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6819 @end deffn
6820
6821 @deffn Command {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
6822 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
6823 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6824 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
6825 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
6826
6827 Example usage:
6828 @example
6829 # read OPTSR_CUR
6830 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
6831 # read WPSN_CUR1R
6832 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
6833 # read WPSN_CUR2R
6834 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
6835 @end example
6836 @end deffn
6837
6838 @deffn Command {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
6839 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
6840 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6841 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
6842 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
6843 will be touched).
6844
6845 Example usage:
6846 @example
6847 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices, by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
6848 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
6849 @end example
6850 @end deffn
6851 @end deffn
6852
6853 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
6854 All members of the STM32L microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6855 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
6856 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6857 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6858
6859 @example
6860 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6861 @end example
6862
6863 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6864 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6865 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
6866 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
6867 second bank.
6868
6869 @example
6870 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6871 @end example
6872
6873 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
6874
6875 @deffn Command {stm32lx lock} num
6876 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6877 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6878 @end deffn
6879
6880 @deffn Command {stm32lx unlock} num
6881 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6882 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6883 @end deffn
6884
6885 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
6886 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
6887 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
6888 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
6889 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6890 @end deffn
6891 @end deffn
6892
6893 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32l4x
6894 All members of the STM32L4 and STM32WB microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6895 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6896 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6897 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6898
6899 @example
6900 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6901 @end example
6902
6903 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6904 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6905 the flash driver.
6906
6907 @example
6908 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6909 @end example
6910
6911 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
6912
6913 @deffn Command {stm32l4x lock} num
6914 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6915 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6916 @end deffn
6917
6918 @deffn Command {stm32l4x unlock} num
6919 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6920 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6921 @end deffn
6922
6923 @deffn Command {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
6924 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
6925 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6926 @end deffn
6927
6928 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
6929 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
6930 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6931 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
6932
6933 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
6934 @example
6935 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
6936 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
6937 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
6938 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
6939 @end example
6940
6941 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
6942 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
6943 @end deffn
6944
6945 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
6946 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
6947 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6948 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
6949 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
6950
6951 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
6952 @example
6953 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
6954 @end example
6955
6956 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
6957 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
6958 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
6959 @end deffn
6960
6961 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_load} num
6962 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a reset of the device.
6963 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6964 @end deffn
6965 @end deffn
6966
6967 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
6968 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
6969 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6970 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
6971 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
6972
6973 @example
6974 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
6975 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
6976 @end example
6977
6978 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
6979 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
6980 for the specified flash bank.
6981 @end deffn
6982 @end deffn
6983
6984 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
6985 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
6986 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
6987 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
6988 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
6989
6990 @example
6991 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6992 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
6993 @end example
6994
6995 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
6996 Configures the str9 flash controller.
6997 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6998
6999 @itemize @bullet
7000 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
7001 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
7002 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7003 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7004 @end itemize
7005 @end deffn
7006
7007 @end deffn
7008
7009 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
7010 @cindex str9xpec
7011
7012 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
7013 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
7014 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
7015 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
7016
7017 Here is some background info to help
7018 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
7019 the str9:
7020 @enumerate
7021 @item
7022 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7023 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7024 @item
7025 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7026 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7027 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7028 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7029 @end enumerate
7030
7031 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7032 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7033 configured for flash bank 0.
7034 @example
7035 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7036 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7037 adapter assert srst
7038 # turn off target polling
7039 poll off
7040 # disable str9 core
7041 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7042 # read option bytes
7043 str9xpec options_read 0
7044 # re-enable str9 core
7045 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7046 poll on
7047 reset halt
7048 @end example
7049 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7050 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7051 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7052 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7053
7054 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7055
7056 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7057 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7058 @end deffn
7059
7060 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7061 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7062 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7063 @end deffn
7064
7065 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
7066 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7067 erase the device.
7068 @end deffn
7069
7070 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
7071 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7072 @end deffn
7073
7074 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7075 Configure str9 boot bank.
7076 @end deffn
7077
7078 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7079 Configure str9 lvd source.
7080 @end deffn
7081
7082 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7083 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7084 @end deffn
7085
7086 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7087 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7088 @end deffn
7089
7090 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
7091 Read str9 option bytes.
7092 @end deffn
7093
7094 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
7095 Write str9 option bytes.
7096 @end deffn
7097
7098 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
7099 unlock str9 device.
7100 @end deffn
7101
7102 @end deffn
7103
7104 @deffn {Flash Driver} swm050
7105 @cindex swm050
7106 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7107
7108 @example
7109 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7110 @end example
7111
7112 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7113
7114 @deffn Command {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7115 Erases the entire flash bank.
7116 @end deffn
7117
7118 @end deffn
7119
7120
7121 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
7122 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7123 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7124 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7125
7126 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7127
7128 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7129 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7130 @end deffn
7131
7132 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
7133 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7134 @end deffn
7135
7136 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
7137 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
7138 the flash clock.
7139 @end deffn
7140 @end deffn
7141
7142 @deffn {Flash Driver} w600
7143 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
7144 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
7145 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
7146 correct bank config.
7147
7148 @example
7149 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7150 @end example
7151 @end deffn
7152
7153 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc1xxx
7154 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7155 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7156 @end deffn
7157
7158 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc4xxx
7159 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7160 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7161
7162 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7163
7164 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7165 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7166 @end deffn
7167
7168 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
7169 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
7170 @end deffn
7171
7172 @end deffn
7173
7174 @section NAND Flash Commands
7175 @cindex NAND
7176
7177 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
7178 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
7179 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
7180
7181 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
7182 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
7183 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
7184 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
7185 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
7186 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
7187
7188 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
7189 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
7190 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
7191 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
7192 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
7193 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
7194 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
7195 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
7196 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
7197 with techniques such as wear leveling.
7198
7199 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
7200 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
7201 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
7202 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
7203 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
7204 every 512 bytes of data.
7205
7206 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
7207 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
7208 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
7209 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
7210 ECC mode is used.
7211
7212 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
7213 @enumerate
7214 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
7215 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
7216 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
7217 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
7218 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
7219 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
7220 to access that device.
7221 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
7222 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
7223 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
7224 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
7225 de-brick a board.
7226 @end enumerate
7227
7228 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
7229 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
7230 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
7231 are only 32 bits wide.
7232 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
7233 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
7234 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
7235 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
7236
7237 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
7238 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
7239 @cindex NAND configuration
7240
7241 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
7242 plus some additional configuration that's done after
7243 OpenOCD has initialized.
7244
7245 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7246 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7247 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7248 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7249 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7250 they were a single (larger) device.
7251 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7252 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7253
7254 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7255 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7256 configuration files, not interactively.
7257
7258 @itemize @bullet
7259 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7260 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7261 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7262 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7263 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7264 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7265 commands to the NAND controller.
7266 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7267 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7268 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7269 for more information.
7270 @end itemize
7271 @end deffn
7272
7273 @deffn Command {nand list}
7274 Prints a summary of each device declared
7275 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7276 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7277 @example
7278 > nand list
7279 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7280 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7281 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7282 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7283 >
7284 @end example
7285 @end deffn
7286
7287 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
7288 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7289 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7290 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7291 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7292 it with most other NAND commands.
7293 @end deffn
7294
7295 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7296
7297 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7298 @cindex NAND reading
7299 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7300 starting at the specified offset.
7301 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7302
7303 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7304 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7305
7306 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7307 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7308 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7309
7310 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7311 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7312 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7313 method which handled that error correction.
7314
7315 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7316 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7317 @itemize @bullet
7318 @item no oob_* parameter
7319 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7320 @item @code{oob_raw}
7321 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7322 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7323 spare areas associated with each data page.
7324 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7325 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7326 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7327 @item @code{oob_only}
7328 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7329 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7330 spare areas associated with each data page.
7331 @end itemize
7332 @end deffn
7333
7334 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
7335 @cindex NAND erasing
7336 @cindex NAND programming
7337 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7338 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7339 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7340 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7341 If those parameters are not specified,
7342 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7343 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7344
7345 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7346 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7347 block marker.
7348 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7349 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7350 @end deffn
7351
7352 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7353 @cindex NAND writing
7354 @cindex NAND programming
7355 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7356 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7357 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7358 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7359
7360 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7361 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7362
7363 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7364 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7365 past the end of the device.
7366 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7367 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7368 if that's being written.)
7369
7370 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7371 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7372 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7373
7374 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7375 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7376 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7377 @itemize @bullet
7378 @item no oob_* parameter
7379 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7380 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7381 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7382 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7383 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7384 @item @code{oob_only}
7385 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7386 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7387 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7388 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7389 @item @code{oob_raw}
7390 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7391 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7392 un-altered OOB.
7393 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7394 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7395 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7396 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7397 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7398 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7399 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7400 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7401 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7402 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7403 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7404 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7405 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7406 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7407 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7408 @end itemize
7409 @end deffn
7410
7411 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7412 @cindex NAND verification
7413 @cindex NAND programming
7414 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7415 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7416 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7417
7418 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7419 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7420
7421 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7422 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7423 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7424 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7425 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7426
7427 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7428 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7429 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7430
7431 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7432 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7433 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7434 be removed in a future release.
7435 @end deffn
7436
7437 @subsection Other NAND commands
7438 @cindex NAND other commands
7439
7440 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7441 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7442 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7443 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7444 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7445 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7446 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7447 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7448
7449 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7450 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7451 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7452 @end deffn
7453
7454 @deffn Command {nand info} num
7455 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7456 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7457 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7458 status for each block.
7459 @end deffn
7460
7461 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7462 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7463 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7464
7465 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7466 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7467 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
7468 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
7469 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
7470
7471 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
7472 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
7473 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
7474 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
7475 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
7476 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
7477 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
7478 @end deffn
7479
7480 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
7481 @subsection NAND Driver List
7482 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
7483 driver-specific options and behaviors.
7484 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
7485
7486 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
7487 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
7488 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
7489 address of the ECC controller.
7490 @example
7491 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
7492 @end example
7493 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
7494 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
7495 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
7496 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
7497 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
7498 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
7499 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
7500 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7501 @end deffn
7502 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
7503 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
7504 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7505 @end deffn
7506
7507 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
7508 properly configured for input or output.
7509 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
7510 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
7511 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7512 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7513 @end deffn
7514 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
7515 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
7516 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7517 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7518 @end deffn
7519 @end deffn
7520
7521 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
7522 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
7523 chips from Texas Instruments.
7524 It takes three extra parameters:
7525 address of the NAND chip;
7526 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
7527 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
7528 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
7529 @example
7530 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
7531 @end example
7532 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
7533 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
7534 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
7535 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
7536 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
7537 @end deffn
7538
7539 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
7540 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7541 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
7542 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
7543 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
7544 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
7545 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7546 @end deffn
7547
7548 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
7549 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
7550 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
7551 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
7552 @end deffn
7553 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
7554
7555 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
7556 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
7557 should work for this chip as well.
7558 @end deffn
7559
7560 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
7561 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
7562 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
7563 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
7564 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
7565 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
7566 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
7567 @example
7568 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
7569 @end example
7570 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
7571 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
7572 without parameter query status.
7573 @end deffn
7574 @end deffn
7575
7576 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
7577 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7578 parameter: the address of the controller.
7579 @example
7580 nand device orion 0xd8000000
7581 @end example
7582 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
7583 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7584 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7585 change any behavior.
7586 @end deffn
7587
7588 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
7589 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
7590 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
7591 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
7592 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
7593 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
7594 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
7595 specialized commands.
7596 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7597 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7598 change any behavior.
7599 @end deffn
7600
7601 @node Flash Programming
7602 @chapter Flash Programming
7603
7604 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
7605 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
7606 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
7607
7608 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
7609 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
7610
7611 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
7612 @enumerate
7613 @item 'init' is executed.
7614 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
7615 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
7616 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
7617 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
7618 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
7619 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
7620 @end enumerate
7621
7622 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
7623
7624 @example
7625 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
7626 # are optional parameters
7627 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7628 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
7629
7630 # binary files need the flash address passing
7631 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7632 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
7633 @end example
7634
7635 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
7636 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
7637 @cindex PLD
7638 @cindex FPGA
7639
7640 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
7641 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
7642 OpenOCD can support programming them.
7643 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
7644 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
7645 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
7646 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
7647
7648 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
7649
7650 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
7651 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
7652 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
7653
7654 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
7655 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
7656
7657 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
7658 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
7659 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
7660 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
7661 behavior.
7662 @end deffn
7663
7664 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
7665 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
7666 @end deffn
7667
7668 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
7669 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
7670 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
7671 @end deffn
7672
7673 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
7674
7675 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
7676 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
7677 that particular type of PLD.
7678
7679 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
7680 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
7681 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
7682
7683 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
7684 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
7685 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
7686
7687 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
7688 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
7689 for FPGA @var{num}.
7690 @end deffn
7691 @end deffn
7692
7693 @node General Commands
7694 @chapter General Commands
7695 @cindex commands
7696
7697 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
7698 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
7699 commands are documented elsewhere.
7700
7701 Intent:
7702 @itemize @bullet
7703 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
7704 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
7705 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
7706 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
7707
7708 @item @b{From the human}
7709 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
7710 or via GDB (default port 3333).
7711
7712 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
7713 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
7714 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
7715
7716 @item @b{Machine Interface}
7717 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
7718 port is 5555.
7719 @end itemize
7720
7721
7722 @section Server Commands
7723
7724 @deffn {Command} exit
7725 Exits the current telnet session.
7726 @end deffn
7727
7728 @deffn {Command} help [string]
7729 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
7730 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
7731 Not every command provides helptext.
7732
7733 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
7734 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
7735 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
7736 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
7737 @end deffn
7738
7739 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
7740 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
7741 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
7742 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
7743 Useful in connection with script files
7744 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
7745 @end deffn
7746
7747 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
7748 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
7749 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
7750 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
7751
7752 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
7753 @example
7754 # redefine shutdown
7755 rename shutdown original_shutdown
7756 proc shutdown @{@} @{
7757 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
7758 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
7759 original_shutdown
7760 @}
7761 @end example
7762 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
7763 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
7764 @end deffn
7765
7766 @anchor{debuglevel}
7767 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
7768 @cindex message level
7769 Display debug level.
7770 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
7771 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
7772 Level 0 is error messages only;
7773 level 1 adds warnings;
7774 level 2 adds informational messages;
7775 level 3 adds debugging messages;
7776 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
7777 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
7778 the command line along with the location of that log
7779 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
7780 @xref{Running}.
7781 @end deffn
7782
7783 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
7784 Logs a message at "user" priority.
7785 Output @var{message} to stdout.
7786 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
7787 @example
7788 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
7789 @end example
7790 @end deffn
7791
7792 @deffn Command log_output [filename]
7793 Redirect logging to @var{filename};
7794 the initial log output channel is stderr.
7795 @end deffn
7796
7797 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
7798 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
7799 @end deffn
7800
7801 @deffn Command bindto [@var{name}]
7802 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
7803 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
7804 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
7805 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
7806 @end deffn
7807
7808 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
7809 @section Target State handling
7810 @cindex reset
7811 @cindex halt
7812 @cindex target initialization
7813
7814 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
7815 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
7816 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
7817 a current target which is used to perform the
7818 various operations. The current target may be changed
7819 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
7820 target which should become current.
7821
7822 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
7823 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
7824 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
7825 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
7826 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
7827
7828 @emph{With no arguments}:
7829 list all available registers for the current target,
7830 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
7831 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
7832 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
7833 are flagged as such.
7834
7835 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
7836 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
7837 bypassing any internal cache.
7838
7839 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
7840 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
7841 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
7842 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
7843 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
7844 relevant module will flush such values.
7845
7846 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
7847 Debug and trace infrastructure:
7848
7849 @example
7850 > reg
7851 ===== ARM registers
7852 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
7853 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
7854 (2) r2 (/32)
7855 ...
7856 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
7857 >
7858 @end example
7859 @end deffn
7860
7861 @deffn Command halt [ms]
7862 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
7863 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
7864 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
7865 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
7866 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
7867 (and enter debug mode).
7868 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
7869
7870 @quotation Warning
7871 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
7872 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
7873 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
7874 power mode by gating the core clock;
7875 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
7876
7877 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
7878 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
7879 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
7880 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
7881 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
7882 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
7883
7884 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
7885 work with a JTAG debugger.
7886 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
7887 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
7888 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
7889 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
7890 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
7891 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
7892 @end quotation
7893
7894 @end deffn
7895
7896 @deffn Command resume [address]
7897 Resume the target at its current code position,
7898 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
7899 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
7900 @end deffn
7901
7902 @deffn Command step [address]
7903 Single-step the target at its current code position,
7904 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
7905 @end deffn
7906
7907 @anchor{resetcommand}
7908 @deffn Command reset
7909 @deffnx Command {reset run}
7910 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
7911 @deffnx Command {reset init}
7912 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
7913 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
7914 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
7915
7916 The optional parameter specifies what should
7917 happen after the reset.
7918 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
7919 The other options will not work on all systems.
7920 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
7921
7922 @itemize @minus
7923 @item @b{run} Let the target run
7924 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
7925 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
7926 @end itemize
7927 @end deffn
7928
7929 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
7930 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
7931 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
7932 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
7933 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
7934 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
7935 state.
7936 @end deffn
7937
7938 @deffn Command {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
7939 @deffnx Command {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
7940 Set values of reset signals.
7941 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
7942 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
7943 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
7944 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
7945
7946 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
7947 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
7948 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
7949 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
7950 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
7951 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
7952 the signal will not be modified.
7953
7954 @quotation Note
7955 TRST is specially handled.
7956 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
7957 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
7958 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
7959 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
7960 instead of the TRST signal.
7961 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
7962 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
7963 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
7964 with handlers for that event.
7965 @end quotation
7966 @end deffn
7967
7968 @section I/O Utilities
7969
7970 These commands are available when
7971 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
7972 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
7973 notably the ZY1000.
7974 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
7975
7976 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
7977
7978 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
7979 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
7980 the text file @file{filename}.
7981 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
7982 The last string is followed by a newline.
7983 @end deffn
7984
7985 @deffn Command cat filename
7986 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
7987 @end deffn
7988
7989 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
7990 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
7991 into @file{dest_filename}.
7992 @end deffn
7993
7994 @deffn Command ip
7995 @emph{No description provided.}
7996 @end deffn
7997
7998 @deffn Command ls
7999 @emph{No description provided.}
8000 @end deffn
8001
8002 @deffn Command mac
8003 @emph{No description provided.}
8004 @end deffn
8005
8006 @deffn Command meminfo
8007 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
8008 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
8009 @end deffn
8010
8011 @deffn Command peek
8012 @emph{No description provided.}
8013 @end deffn
8014
8015 @deffn Command poke
8016 @emph{No description provided.}
8017 @end deffn
8018
8019 @deffn Command rm filename
8020 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
8021 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
8022 @end deffn
8023
8024 @deffn Command trunc filename
8025 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
8026 @end deffn
8027
8028 @anchor{memoryaccess}
8029 @section Memory access commands
8030 @cindex memory access
8031
8032 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
8033 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
8034 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
8035 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
8036
8037 @enumerate
8038 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
8039 to change the current target.
8040 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
8041 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
8042 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
8043 @end enumerate
8044
8045 @deffn Command mdd [phys] addr [count]
8046 @deffnx Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
8047 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
8048 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
8049 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8050 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8051 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8052 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8053 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8054 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8055 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8056 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8057 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8058 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
8059 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
8060 @end deffn
8061
8062 @deffn Command mwd [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8063 @deffnx Command mww [phys] addr word [count]
8064 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword [count]
8065 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte [count]
8066 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8067 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8068 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8069 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8070 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8071 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8072 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8073 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8074 @end deffn
8075
8076 @anchor{imageaccess}
8077 @section Image loading commands
8078 @cindex image loading
8079 @cindex image dumping
8080
8081 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
8082 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8083 binary file named @var{filename}.
8084 @end deffn
8085
8086 @deffn Command {fast_load}
8087 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8088 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8089 @end deffn
8090
8091 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8092 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8093 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8094 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8095 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8096 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8097 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8098 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8099 separately.
8100 @end deffn
8101
8102 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8103 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8104 The file format may optionally be specified
8105 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8106 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8107 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8108 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8109 @example
8110 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8111 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8112 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8113 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
8114 $address $length
8115 @}
8116 @end example
8117 @end deffn
8118
8119 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
8120 Displays image section sizes and addresses
8121 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8122 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8123 The file format may optionally be specified
8124 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8125 @end deffn
8126
8127 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8128 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8129 The file format may optionally be specified
8130 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8131 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8132 @end deffn
8133
8134 @deffn Command {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8135 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8136 The file format may optionally be specified
8137 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8138 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8139 @end deffn
8140
8141
8142 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8143 @cindex breakpoint
8144 @cindex watchpoint
8145
8146 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8147 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8148 watchpoints.
8149 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
8150
8151 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
8152 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
8153 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
8154 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8155 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
8156 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
8157
8158 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
8159 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
8160 @end deffn
8161
8162 @deffn Command {rbp} address
8163 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address}.
8164 @end deffn
8165
8166 @deffn Command {rwp} address
8167 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
8168 @end deffn
8169
8170 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
8171 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
8172 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8173 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
8174 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
8175 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
8176 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
8177 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
8178 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
8179 @end deffn
8180
8181 @section Misc Commands
8182
8183 @cindex profiling
8184 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
8185 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
8186 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
8187 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
8188 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
8189 limit the address range.
8190 @end deffn
8191
8192 @deffn Command {version}
8193 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
8194 @end deffn
8195
8196 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
8197 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
8198 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
8199 @end deffn
8200
8201 @node Architecture and Core Commands
8202 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
8203 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
8204 @cindex Core Specific Commands
8205
8206 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
8207 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
8208 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
8209 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
8210
8211 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
8212 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
8213 @cindex tracing
8214 @cindex ETM
8215 @cindex ETB
8216
8217 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
8218 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
8219 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8220
8221 @itemize
8222 @item
8223 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8224 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8225 supports such an interface.
8226 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8227 and trace port support.)
8228 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8229 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8230 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8231 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8232 in the board-specific configuration file.
8233 @item
8234 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8235 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8236 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8237 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8238 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8239 @end itemize
8240
8241 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8242
8243 @quotation Issues
8244 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8245 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8246
8247 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8248 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8249 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8250 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8251 dummy trace port driver}.
8252
8253 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8254 as well as tracing only during specific states
8255 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8256
8257 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8258 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8259 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8260 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8261 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8262
8263 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8264 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8265 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8266 this original style of JTAG access.
8267 @end quotation
8268
8269 @subsection ETM Configuration
8270 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8271
8272 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8273 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8274 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8275
8276 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8277 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8278 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8279 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8280 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8281 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8282 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8283 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8284 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8285
8286 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8287 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8288 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8289
8290 @quotation Warning
8291 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8292 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8293 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8294 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8295 @end quotation
8296
8297 @quotation Note
8298 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8299 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8300 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8301 what CPU activities are traced.
8302 @end quotation
8303 @end deffn
8304
8305 @deffn Command {etm info}
8306 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8307 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8308 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8309 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8310 @end deffn
8311
8312 @deffn Command {etm status}
8313 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8314 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8315 Did trace data overflow?
8316 Was it triggered?
8317 @end deffn
8318
8319 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8320 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8321 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8322 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8323 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8324
8325 @itemize
8326 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8327 when they pass any ViewData filtering that that was set up.
8328 The value is one of
8329 @option{none} (save nothing),
8330 @option{data} (save data),
8331 @option{address} (save addresses),
8332 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8333 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8334 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8335 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8336 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8337 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8338 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8339 trace stream without an image of the code.
8340 @end itemize
8341 @end deffn
8342
8343 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8344 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8345 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8346 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8347 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8348
8349 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8350 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8351 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8352 @end deffn
8353
8354 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8355
8356 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8357 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8358 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8359
8360 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8361 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8362 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8363 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8364 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8365 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8366 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8367
8368 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8369
8370 @itemize
8371 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8372 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8373 for instruction access within that function's body.
8374 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8375 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8376 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8377 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8378 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8379 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8380 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8381 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8382 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8383 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8384 @item @emph{... more}
8385 @end itemize
8386
8387 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8388 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8389
8390 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
8391 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8392 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8393 @end deffn
8394
8395 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
8396 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8397 @end deffn
8398
8399 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8400 Opens an image file.
8401 @end deffn
8402
8403 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
8404 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8405 @end deffn
8406
8407 @deffn Command {etm start}
8408 Starts trace data collection.
8409 @end deffn
8410
8411 @deffn Command {etm stop}
8412 Stops trace data collection.
8413 @end deffn
8414
8415 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8416 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8417
8418 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8419
8420 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
8421 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8422 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8423 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8424 any trace data collection.}
8425 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
8426 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
8427 @end deffn
8428 @end deffn
8429
8430 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
8431 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
8432 to use on-chip ETB memory.
8433 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
8434 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
8435 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
8436 @end deffn
8437 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
8438 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
8439 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
8440 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
8441 trace trigger becomes active.
8442
8443 @itemize
8444 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
8445 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
8446 afterwards.
8447 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
8448 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
8449 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
8450 what caused that event to happen.
8451 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
8452 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
8453 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
8454 how the event caused trouble.
8455 @end itemize
8456 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
8457 @end deffn
8458
8459 @end deffn
8460
8461 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
8462 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
8463 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
8464 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
8465 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
8466
8467 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8468 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
8469
8470 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
8471 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
8472 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
8473 @end deffn
8474
8475 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
8476 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
8477 @end deffn
8478
8479 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
8480 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
8481 @end deffn
8482 @end deffn
8483
8484 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
8485 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
8486 @cindex CTI
8487
8488 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
8489 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
8490 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
8491 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
8492 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
8493 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
8494
8495 @deffn Command {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-ctibase} base_address
8496 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
8497 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
8498 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
8499 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
8500 including additional configuration.
8501 @end deffn
8502
8503 @deffn Command {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
8504 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
8505 @end deffn
8506
8507 @deffn Command {$cti_name dump}
8508 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
8509 @end deffn
8510
8511 @deffn Command {$cti_name write } @var{reg_name} @var{value}
8512 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8513 @end deffn
8514
8515 @deffn Command {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
8516 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8517 @end deffn
8518
8519 @deffn Command {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
8520 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
8521 @end deffn
8522
8523 @deffn Command {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
8524 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
8525 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
8526 @end deffn
8527
8528 @deffn Command {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
8529 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
8530 of the CTI.
8531 @end deffn
8532
8533 @deffn Command {cti names}
8534 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
8535 useful in TCL scripting.
8536 @end deffn
8537
8538 @section Generic ARM
8539 @cindex ARM
8540
8541 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
8542 They are available in addition to other core-specific
8543 commands that may be available.
8544
8545 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
8546 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
8547 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
8548 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
8549 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8550 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
8551 @end deffn
8552
8553 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
8554 @cindex disassemble
8555 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
8556 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
8557 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
8558 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
8559 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
8560 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8561 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
8562
8563 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
8564 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
8565 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
8566 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
8567 with a handful of exceptions.
8568 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
8569 @end deffn
8570
8571 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
8572 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
8573 passing parameters @var{CRn},
8574 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8575 and using the MCR instruction.
8576 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8577 an ARM register.)
8578 @end deffn
8579
8580 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
8581 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
8582 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8583 and the MRC instruction.
8584 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
8585 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8586 an ARM register.)
8587 @end deffn
8588
8589 @deffn Command {arm reg}
8590 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
8591 core mode if necessary.
8592 @end deffn
8593
8594 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8595 @cindex ARM semihosting
8596 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
8597
8598 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
8599 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
8600 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
8601 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
8602 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
8603 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
8604 @end deffn
8605
8606 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8607 @cindex ARM semihosting
8608 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
8609
8610 @example
8611 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
8612 @end example
8613
8614 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
8615 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
8616 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
8617 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
8618 @end deffn
8619
8620 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8621 @cindex ARM semihosting
8622 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
8623 status.
8624
8625 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
8626 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
8627 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
8628 debugger.
8629 @end deffn
8630
8631 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8632 @cindex ARM semihosting
8633 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
8634
8635 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
8636 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
8637 the value returned by the target.
8638
8639 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
8640 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
8641 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
8642 encountering a break.
8643
8644 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
8645 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
8646 to the debugger.
8647 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
8648 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
8649 request or equivalent").
8650
8651 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
8652 this option (default: disabled).
8653 @end deffn
8654
8655 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
8656 @cindex ARMv4
8657 @cindex ARMv5
8658
8659 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
8660 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
8661 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
8662 variant.
8663
8664 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
8665 @cindex ARM7
8666 @cindex ARM9
8667
8668 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
8669 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
8670 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
8671 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
8672
8673 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8674 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
8675 the EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
8676 instead of breakpoints.
8677 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8678
8679 This should be
8680 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
8681 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
8682 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
8683 @end deffn
8684
8685 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8686 @cindex DCC
8687 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
8688 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
8689 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8690
8691 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
8692 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
8693 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
8694 @end deffn
8695
8696 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8697 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
8698 that don't check completion of the operation.
8699 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8700
8701 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
8702 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
8703 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
8704 @end deffn
8705
8706 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
8707 @cindex ARM720T
8708
8709 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
8710 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8711 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
8712 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
8713
8714 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
8715 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8716 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8717
8718 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
8719 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8720 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
8721 @end deffn
8722
8723 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
8724 @cindex ARM9
8725
8726 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
8727 integer processors.
8728 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
8729
8730 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
8731 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
8732 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
8733 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
8734
8735 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
8736 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
8737 @cindex vector_catch
8738 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
8739 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
8740 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
8741 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
8742 to those hardware vectors.
8743
8744 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
8745 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
8746 vector catch hardware to intercept
8747 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
8748 @option{none} of them,
8749 or a list with one or more of the following:
8750 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
8751 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
8752 @end deffn
8753
8754 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
8755 @cindex ARM920T
8756
8757 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
8758 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8759 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
8760 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8761 and ARM9 commands.
8762
8763 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
8764 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
8765 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
8766 @end deffn
8767
8768 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
8769 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8770 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8771 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
8772 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
8773 (Not all registers can be written.)
8774 @end deffn
8775
8776 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
8777 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8778 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8779
8780 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
8781 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
8782 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
8783 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
8784 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
8785 or using zero if no other address is provided.
8786 @end deffn
8787
8788 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
8789 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
8790 @end deffn
8791
8792 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
8793 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
8794 @end deffn
8795
8796 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
8797 @cindex ARM926ej-s
8798
8799 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
8800 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
8801 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
8802 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8803 and ARM9 commands.
8804
8805 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
8806 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
8807
8808 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
8809 Print information about the caches found.
8810 @end deffn
8811
8812 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
8813 @cindex ARM966E
8814
8815 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
8816 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
8817 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8818 and ARM9 commands.
8819
8820 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
8821 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8822 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8823 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
8824 ARM966E-S TRM.
8825 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
8826 as required for BIST support.
8827 @end deffn
8828
8829 @subsection XScale specific commands
8830 @cindex XScale
8831
8832 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
8833
8834 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
8835 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
8836 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
8837 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
8838 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
8839 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
8840 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
8841
8842 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
8843 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
8844 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
8845 the mini-IC.
8846
8847 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
8848 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
8849 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
8850 code layout in memory:
8851 @example
8852 _vectors:
8853 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8854 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8855 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8856 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8857 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8858 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8859 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8860 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8861 .org 0x100
8862 .long real_reset_vector
8863 .long real_ui_handler
8864 .long real_swi_handler
8865 .long real_pf_abort
8866 .long real_data_abort
8867 .long 0 /* unused */
8868 .long real_irq_handler
8869 .long real_fiq_handler
8870 @end example
8871
8872 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
8873 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
8874 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
8875 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
8876 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
8877 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
8878 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
8879 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
8880 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
8881 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
8882 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
8883 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
8884 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
8885 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
8886 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
8887 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
8888 software.
8889
8890 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
8891 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
8892 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
8893 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
8894
8895 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
8896 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
8897 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
8898 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
8899 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
8900 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
8901 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
8902 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
8903 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
8904
8905 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
8906 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
8907
8908 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
8909 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
8910 @end deffn
8911
8912 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
8913 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
8914 @end deffn
8915
8916 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
8917 Displays information about the CPU caches.
8918 @end deffn
8919
8920 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
8921 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8922 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8923 @end deffn
8924
8925 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
8926 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
8927 @end deffn
8928
8929 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8930 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
8931 @end deffn
8932
8933 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
8934 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
8935 @end deffn
8936
8937 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8938 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
8939 @end deffn
8940
8941 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8942 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
8943 @end deffn
8944
8945 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
8946 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
8947 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
8948 and modifying how it is emptied.
8949 @end deffn
8950
8951 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
8952 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
8953 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
8954 The image @var{type} may be one of
8955 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
8956 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
8957 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
8958 @end deffn
8959
8960 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
8961 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
8962 @cindex vector_catch
8963 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
8964 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
8965
8966 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
8967 @example
8968 0x01 Trap Reset
8969 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
8970 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
8971 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
8972 0x10 Trap Data Abort
8973 0x20 reserved
8974 0x40 Trap IRQ
8975 0x80 Trap FIQ
8976 @end example
8977 @end deffn
8978
8979 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
8980 @cindex vector_table
8981
8982 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
8983 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
8984 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
8985 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
8986 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
8987
8988 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
8989
8990 @end deffn
8991
8992 @section ARMv6 Architecture
8993 @cindex ARMv6
8994
8995 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
8996 @cindex ARM11
8997
8998 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8999 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
9000 which is enabled by default.
9001 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9002 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
9003 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
9004 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
9005 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
9006 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
9007 @end deffn
9008
9009 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9010 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
9011 which is enabled by default.
9012 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9013 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
9014 @end deffn
9015
9016 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9017 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
9018 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
9019 they are disabled by default.
9020 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
9021 @end deffn
9022
9023 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
9024 @cindex vector_catch
9025 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
9026 coprocessor 14 register 7.
9027 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
9028
9029 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9030 for certain hardware events.
9031 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
9032 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
9033 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
9034 @end deffn
9035
9036 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
9037 @cindex ARMv7
9038 @cindex ARMv8
9039
9040 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
9041 @cindex Cortex-A
9042
9043 @deffn Command {cortex_a cache_info}
9044 display information about target caches
9045 @end deffn
9046
9047 @deffn Command {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
9048 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
9049 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
9050 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
9051 Defaults to 'off'.
9052 @end deffn
9053
9054 @deffn Command {cortex_a dbginit}
9055 Initialize core debug
9056 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9057 @end deffn
9058
9059 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
9060 Display/set the current SMP mode
9061 @end deffn
9062
9063 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
9064 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
9065 @end deffn
9066
9067 @deffn Command {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9068 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9069 @end deffn
9070
9071 @deffn Command {cache_config l2x} [base way]
9072 configure l2x cache
9073 @end deffn
9074
9075 @deffn Command {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
9076 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
9077 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
9078 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
9079 possible (4096) entries are printed.
9080 @end deffn
9081
9082 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
9083 @cindex Cortex-R
9084
9085 @deffn Command {cortex_r dbginit}
9086 Initialize core debug
9087 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9088 @end deffn
9089
9090 @deffn Command {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9091 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9092 @end deffn
9093
9094
9095 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
9096 @cindex tracing
9097 @cindex SWO
9098 @cindex SWV
9099 @cindex TPIU
9100 @cindex ITM
9101 @cindex ETM
9102
9103 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal (@var{filename} | -)}) @
9104 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
9105 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
9106
9107 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
9108 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
9109 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
9110 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
9111
9112 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
9113 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
9114 debugger adapter features.
9115
9116 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
9117 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
9118
9119 Command options:
9120 @itemize @minus
9121 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
9122 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
9123 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware);
9124 @item @option{internal @var{filename}} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
9125 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename} (which can be
9126 either a regular file or a named pipe);
9127 @item @option{internal -} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
9128 gather trace data, but not write to any file. Useful in conjunction with the @command{tcl_trace} command;
9129 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
9130 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width};
9131 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
9132 coding;
9133 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
9134 regular UART 8N1) coding;
9135 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
9136 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
9137 data is to be output via SWO;
9138 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
9139 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK);
9140 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
9141 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
9142 rate automatically.
9143 @end itemize
9144
9145 Example usage:
9146 @enumerate
9147 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
9148 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
9149 enough to:
9150 @example
9151 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
9152 ...
9153 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
9154 ...
9155 @end example
9156 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
9157 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
9158 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
9159 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
9160 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
9161 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
9162 @example
9163 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
9164 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
9165 @end example
9166 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
9167 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
9168 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
9169 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
9170 @example
9171 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
9172 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
9173 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
9174 -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
9175 @end example
9176 @end enumerate
9177 @end deffn
9178
9179 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9180 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
9181 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
9182 @end deffn
9183
9184 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9185 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
9186 @end deffn
9187
9188 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
9189 @cindex Cortex-M
9190
9191 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
9192 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
9193
9194 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
9195 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
9196 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
9197 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
9198 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
9199 the step command leaves with the core running.
9200
9201 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
9202 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
9203 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
9204 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
9205
9206 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
9207 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
9208 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
9209 does.
9210
9211 Default is @option{auto}.
9212 @end deffn
9213
9214 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9215 @cindex vector_catch
9216 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9217 for certain hardware events.
9218
9219 Parameters request interception of
9220 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
9221 @option{none} of them,
9222 or one or more of the following:
9223 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
9224 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
9225 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
9226 @option{irq_err},
9227 @option{state_err},
9228 @option{chk_err}, or
9229 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9230 @option{reset}.
9231 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9232 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9233 are mapped to HardFault.
9234 UsageFault checks for
9235 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9236 must also be explicitly enabled.
9237
9238 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9239 @end deffn
9240
9241 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9242 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9243 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9244
9245 @itemize @minus
9246 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9247 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9248 @end itemize
9249
9250 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9251 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9252 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9253 to manually reset the peripherals.
9254 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9255
9256 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9257 instead.
9258 @end deffn
9259
9260 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9261 @cindex ARMv8-A
9262 @cindex aarch64
9263
9264 @deffn Command {aarch64 cache_info}
9265 Display information about target caches
9266 @end deffn
9267
9268 @deffn Command {aarch64 dbginit}
9269 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9270 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9271 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9272 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9273 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9274 @end deffn
9275
9276 @deffn Command {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
9277 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9278 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9279 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9280 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9281 @end deffn
9282
9283 @deffn Command {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9284 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9285 @option{on}.
9286 @end deffn
9287
9288 @deffn Command {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
9289 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
9290 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
9291 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
9292 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
9293 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
9294 @end deffn
9295
9296 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9297
9298 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9299 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9300
9301 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9302
9303 @deffn Command {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9304 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9305 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9306 @end deffn
9307
9308 @deffn Command {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9309 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9310 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9311 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9312 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9313 @end deffn
9314
9315 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9316
9317 @deffn Command {esirisc flush_caches}
9318 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9319 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9320 @end deffn
9321
9322 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9323
9324 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9325 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9326 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9327 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9328 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9329 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9330 can be collected.
9331
9332 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9333 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9334 tooling.
9335
9336 @quotation Issues
9337 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9338 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9339 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9340 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9341
9342 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9343 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9344 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9345 software operation on the CPU.
9346 @end quotation
9347
9348 @deffn Command {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9349 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9350 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
9351 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
9352 @end deffn
9353
9354 @deffn Command {esirisc trace fifo} address
9355 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
9356 @end deffn
9357
9358 @deffn Command {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9359 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
9360 control is disabled.
9361 @end deffn
9362
9363 @deffn Command {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
9364 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
9365 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
9366 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
9367
9368 Supported trace formats:
9369 @itemize
9370 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
9371 timing to be determined.
9372 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
9373 addresses.
9374 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
9375 @end itemize
9376 @end deffn
9377
9378 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
9379 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
9380 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
9381 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9382
9383 Supported conditions:
9384 @itemize
9385 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
9386 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
9387 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
9388 instruction matches start data and mask.
9389 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
9390 instruction matches start data and mask.
9391 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
9392 data and mask.
9393 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9394 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9395 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9396 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
9397 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
9398 @end itemize
9399 @end deffn
9400
9401 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
9402 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
9403 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
9404 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9405
9406 Supported conditions:
9407 @itemize
9408 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
9409 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
9410 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
9411 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9412 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
9413 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9414 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
9415 data and mask.
9416 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9417 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9418 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9419 @end itemize
9420 @end deffn
9421
9422 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
9423 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
9424
9425 Supported triggers:
9426 @itemize
9427 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
9428 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
9429 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
9430 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
9431 collection.
9432 @end itemize
9433 @end deffn
9434
9435 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
9436
9437 @deffn Command {esirisc trace init}
9438 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
9439 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
9440 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
9441 @end deffn
9442
9443 @deffn Command {esirisc trace info}
9444 Display trace configuration.
9445 @end deffn
9446
9447 @deffn Command {esirisc trace status}
9448 Display trace collection status.
9449 @end deffn
9450
9451 @deffn Command {esirisc trace start}
9452 Start manual trace collection.
9453 @end deffn
9454
9455 @deffn Command {esirisc trace stop}
9456 Stop manual trace collection.
9457 @end deffn
9458
9459 @deffn Command {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
9460 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
9461 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
9462 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9463 @option{size} options using DMA.
9464 @end deffn
9465
9466 @deffn Command {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
9467 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
9468 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
9469 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9470 @option{size} options using DMA.
9471 @end deffn
9472
9473 @section Intel Architecture
9474
9475 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
9476 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
9477 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
9478 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
9479 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
9480 @itemize
9481 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
9482 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
9483 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
9484 @end itemize
9485
9486 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
9487 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
9488 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
9489
9490 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
9491 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9492 @end deffn
9493
9494 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
9495 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9496 @end deffn
9497
9498 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
9499 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9500 @end deffn
9501
9502 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
9503 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9504 @end deffn
9505
9506 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
9507 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9508 @end deffn
9509
9510 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
9511 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9512 @end deffn
9513
9514 @section OpenRISC Architecture
9515
9516 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
9517 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
9518
9519 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
9520 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
9521 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
9522 @end deffn
9523 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
9524 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
9525
9526 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
9527
9528 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
9529 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
9530 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
9531 @end deffn
9532
9533 @subsection Registers commands
9534 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
9535 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
9536 included in the generated target descriptor file.
9537
9538 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
9539
9540 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
9541 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
9542 and "timer" groups.
9543
9544 @emph{example:}
9545 @example
9546 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
9547 @end example
9548
9549
9550 @end deffn
9551 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
9552 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
9553
9554 @emph{group} can be "system",
9555 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
9556 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
9557 @end deffn
9558
9559 @section RISC-V Architecture
9560
9561 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
9562 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
9563 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
9564 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
9565 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
9566 implement version 0.11.
9567
9568 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
9569
9570 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
9571 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
9572 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
9573
9574 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
9575
9576 @deffn Command {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9577 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
9578 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
9579
9580 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
9581 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
9582 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
9583 CSRs.
9584 @end deffn
9585
9586 @deffn Command {riscv expose_custom} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9587 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
9588 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
9589 configures a list of inclusive ranges of those registers to expose. Number 0
9590 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
9591 This command must be executed before `init`.
9592 @end deffn
9593
9594 @deffn Command {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9595 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
9596 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
9597 @end deffn
9598
9599 @deffn Command {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9600 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
9601 deasserted.
9602 @end deffn
9603
9604 @deffn Command {riscv set_scratch_ram} none|[address]
9605 Set the address of 16 bytes of scratch RAM the debugger can use, or 'none'.
9606 This is used to access 64-bit floating point registers on 32-bit targets.
9607 @end deffn
9608
9609 @deffn Command {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
9610 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off, prefer to
9611 use the Program Buffer to access memory.
9612 @end deffn
9613
9614 @deffn Command {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
9615 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
9616 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
9617 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
9618 values.
9619
9620 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
9621 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
9622 and DBUS registers, respectively.
9623 @end deffn
9624
9625 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
9626
9627 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
9628 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
9629 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
9630 @example
9631 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
9632 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
9633 @end example
9634
9635 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_read}
9636 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
9637 @end deffn
9638
9639 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_write} value
9640 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
9641 @end deffn
9642
9643 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
9644
9645 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
9646 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
9647
9648 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_read}
9649 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
9650 @end deffn
9651
9652 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_write} address value
9653 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
9654 @end deffn
9655
9656 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
9657 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
9658 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
9659 @cindex tracing
9660 @cindex libdcc
9661 @cindex DCC
9662 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
9663 the target uses appropriate libraries.
9664 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
9665 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
9666
9667 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
9668 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
9669 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
9670 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
9671 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
9672 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
9673
9674 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
9675 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
9676 arrays of various size integers from the target,
9677 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
9678 The target being debugged may
9679 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
9680 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
9681 each supported by a command:
9682
9683 @itemize
9684 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
9685 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
9686 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
9687 finding out how some fault was triggered.
9688
9689 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
9690 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
9691 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
9692
9693 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
9694 and then displayed at any time.
9695 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
9696
9697 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
9698 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
9699 @end itemize
9700
9701 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
9702 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
9703 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
9704 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
9705 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
9706 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
9707 does the same thing.
9708
9709 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
9710 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
9711 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
9712 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
9713 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
9714
9715 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
9716 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
9717 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
9718 @end deffn
9719
9720 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
9721 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
9722 in the order they triggered.
9723 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
9724 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
9725 history records.
9726 @end deffn
9727
9728 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
9729 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
9730 they have been triggered.
9731 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
9732 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
9733 and associates it with that identifier.
9734
9735 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
9736 are not related except by this command.
9737 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
9738 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
9739 @end deffn
9740
9741
9742 @node JTAG Commands
9743 @chapter JTAG Commands
9744 @cindex JTAG Commands
9745 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
9746 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
9747 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
9748 may be needed to work with targets which require special
9749 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
9750
9751 To use these commands you will need to understand some
9752 of the basics of JTAG, including:
9753
9754 @itemize @bullet
9755 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
9756 devices such as a CPUs.
9757 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
9758 standard state machine (in parallel)
9759 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
9760 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
9761 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
9762 while the reading previous ones.
9763 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
9764 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
9765 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
9766 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
9767 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
9768 registers.
9769 @end itemize
9770
9771 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
9772
9773 These commands are used by developers who need to access
9774 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
9775 the order of TAP state transitions.
9776 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
9777 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
9778 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
9779 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
9780 these commands are not available.
9781
9782 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
9783 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
9784 that specify the entire register.
9785 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
9786 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
9787 The return value holds the original value of each
9788 of those fields.
9789
9790 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
9791 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
9792 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
9793 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
9794 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
9795
9796 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
9797 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
9798
9799 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
9800 in that state.
9801 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
9802 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
9803 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
9804
9805 @quotation Warning
9806 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
9807 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
9808 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
9809 data registers, which may have different lengths.
9810 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
9811 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
9812 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
9813 (by connecting a different scan chain).
9814 @end quotation
9815 @end deffn
9816
9817 @deffn Command {flush_count}
9818 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
9819 This may be used for performance tuning.
9820
9821 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
9822 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
9823 not change with the amount of data which is written.
9824 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
9825 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
9826 instead of batching them into larger operations.
9827 @end deffn
9828
9829 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
9830 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
9831 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
9832 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
9833 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
9834 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
9835
9836 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
9837 in that state.
9838 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
9839 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
9840 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
9841
9842 @quotation Note
9843 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
9844 register values, unlike data register values.
9845 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
9846 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
9847 @end quotation
9848 @end deffn
9849
9850 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
9851 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
9852 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
9853 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
9854 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
9855 Then, in a series of single state transitions
9856 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
9857 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
9858 The final state must also be stable.
9859 @end deffn
9860
9861 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
9862 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
9863 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
9864 Instructions often need some time
9865 to execute before they take effect.
9866 @end deffn
9867
9868 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
9869 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
9870
9871 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9872 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
9873 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
9874 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
9875 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
9876 @end deffn
9877
9878 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9879 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
9880 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
9881 must also be enabled.
9882 Default is enabled.
9883 @end deffn
9884
9885 @section TAP state names
9886 @cindex TAP state names
9887
9888 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
9889 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
9890 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
9891 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
9892
9893 @itemize @bullet
9894 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
9895 acts as if TRST were pulsed
9896 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
9897 @item @b{DRSELECT}
9898 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
9899 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
9900 through the data register
9901 @item @b{DREXIT1}
9902 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
9903 for update or more shifting
9904 @item @b{DREXIT2}
9905 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
9906 @item @b{IRSELECT}
9907 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
9908 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
9909 through the instruction register
9910 @item @b{IREXIT1}
9911 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
9912 for update or more shifting
9913 @item @b{IREXIT2}
9914 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
9915 @end itemize
9916
9917 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
9918 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
9919 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
9920 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
9921
9922 @itemize @bullet
9923 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
9924 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
9925 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
9926 may not be as expected.
9927 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
9928 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
9929 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
9930 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
9931 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
9932 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
9933 @end itemize
9934
9935 @node Boundary Scan Commands
9936 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
9937
9938 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
9939 boundary scan based hardware testing.
9940 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
9941 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
9942
9943 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
9944 @cindex Serial Vector Format
9945 @cindex SVF
9946
9947 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
9948 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
9949 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
9950 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
9951
9952 @deffn Command {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
9953 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
9954 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
9955 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
9956
9957 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
9958 affect their semantics.
9959
9960 Command options:
9961 @itemize @minus
9962 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
9963 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
9964 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
9965 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
9966 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
9967 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
9968 on the real interface;
9969 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
9970 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
9971 errors.
9972 @end itemize
9973 @end deffn
9974
9975 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
9976 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
9977 @cindex XSVF
9978
9979 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
9980 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
9981 Xilinx devices.
9982 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
9983 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
9984
9985 @quotation Important
9986 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
9987 @end quotation
9988
9989 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
9990 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
9991 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
9992 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
9993 that TAP.
9994 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
9995 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
9996 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
9997 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
9998 @end deffn
9999
10000 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
10001 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
10002 after building the software.
10003 You may find them useful:
10004
10005 @itemize
10006 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
10007 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
10008 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
10009 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
10010 @end itemize
10011
10012 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
10013 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
10014 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
10015 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
10016 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
10017 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
10018 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
10019
10020
10021 @node Utility Commands
10022 @chapter Utility Commands
10023 @cindex Utility Commands
10024
10025 @section RAM testing
10026 @cindex RAM testing
10027
10028 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
10029 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
10030 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
10031 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
10032 hardware problems.
10033
10034 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
10035 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
10036 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
10037 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
10038
10039 Load the memory testing functions with
10040
10041 @example
10042 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
10043 @end example
10044
10045 to get access to the following facilities:
10046
10047 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
10048 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
10049 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
10050 @end deffn
10051
10052 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
10053 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
10054 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
10055 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
10056 @end deffn
10057
10058 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
10059 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
10060 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
10061 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
10062 @end deffn
10063
10064 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
10065 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
10066 @end deffn
10067
10068 @section Firmware recovery helpers
10069 @cindex Firmware recovery
10070
10071 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
10072 devices recovery with JTAG.
10073
10074 For quickstart instructions run:
10075 @example
10076 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
10077 @end example
10078
10079 @node TFTP
10080 @chapter TFTP
10081 @cindex TFTP
10082 If OpenOCD runs on an embedded host (as ZY1000 does), then TFTP can
10083 be used to access files on PCs (either the developer's PC or some other PC).
10084
10085 The way this works on the ZY1000 is to prefix a filename by
10086 "/tftp/ip/" and append the TFTP path on the TFTP
10087 server (tftpd). For example,
10088
10089 @example
10090 load_image /tftp/10.0.0.96/c:\temp\abc.elf
10091 @end example
10092
10093 will load c:\temp\abc.elf from the developer pc (10.0.0.96) into memory as
10094 if the file was hosted on the embedded host.
10095
10096 In order to achieve decent performance, you must choose a TFTP server
10097 that supports a packet size bigger than the default packet size (512 bytes). There
10098 are numerous TFTP servers out there (free and commercial) and you will have to do
10099 a bit of googling to find something that fits your requirements.
10100
10101 @node GDB and OpenOCD
10102 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
10103 @cindex GDB
10104 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
10105 to debug remote targets.
10106 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
10107
10108 @itemize
10109 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
10110 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
10111 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
10112 as shown in this chapter.
10113 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
10114 that also will probably need to be configured.
10115 @end itemize
10116
10117 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
10118 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
10119 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
10120 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
10121 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
10122 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
10123
10124 @section Connecting to GDB
10125 @cindex Connecting to GDB
10126 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
10127 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
10128 errors, which has since been fixed; see
10129 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
10130
10131 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
10132
10133 @enumerate
10134 @item
10135 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
10136 @example
10137 target remote localhost:3333
10138 @end example
10139 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
10140
10141 It is also possible to use the GDB extended remote protocol as follows:
10142 @example
10143 target extended-remote localhost:3333
10144 @end example
10145 @item
10146 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
10147 @example
10148 target remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
10149 @end example
10150 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
10151 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
10152 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
10153 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
10154 @end enumerate
10155
10156 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
10157 GDB command line.
10158
10159 @section Sample GDB session startup
10160
10161 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
10162 than they do when you're debugging locally.
10163 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
10164 small ARM program.
10165 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
10166 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
10167
10168 @example
10169 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
10170 (gdb) target remote localhost:3333
10171 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
10172 ...
10173 (gdb) monitor reset halt
10174 ...
10175 (gdb) load
10176 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
10177 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
10178 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
10179 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
10180 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
10181 (gdb) continue
10182 Continuing.
10183 ...
10184 @end example
10185
10186 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
10187 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
10188 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
10189 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
10190
10191 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
10192
10193 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
10194 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
10195 packet size and the device's memory map.
10196 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
10197 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
10198 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
10199
10200 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
10201 You may need to set those up by hand.
10202 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
10203 something like:
10204
10205 @example
10206 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
10207 @end example
10208
10209 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
10210
10211 @example
10212 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
10213 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
10214 @end example
10215
10216 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
10217 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
10218 do not have such restrictions.
10219
10220 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
10221 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
10222 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
10223 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
10224
10225 @section Programming using GDB
10226 @cindex Programming using GDB
10227 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
10228
10229 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
10230 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
10231 @example
10232 gdb_memory_map disable
10233 @end example
10234 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
10235 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
10236 working area.
10237
10238 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
10239 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
10240 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
10241 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
10242
10243 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
10244 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
10245
10246 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
10247 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
10248 @example
10249 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
10250 @end example
10251
10252 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
10253 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
10254
10255 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
10256 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
10257 will be used.
10258
10259 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
10260 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
10261 @example
10262 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
10263 @end example
10264 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
10265
10266 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
10267 can be used.
10268
10269 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10270 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10271 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
10272
10273 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
10274 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
10275 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
10276
10277 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
10278 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
10279 and GDB treats it as it were running.
10280 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
10281 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
10282 without any intrusion of the target process.
10283
10284 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
10285 Place following command after target configuration:
10286 @example
10287 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
10288 @end example
10289
10290 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
10291 switch off gdb_memory_map:
10292 @example
10293 gdb_memory_map disable
10294 @end example
10295
10296 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
10297 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
10298 @example
10299 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
10300 @end example
10301
10302 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
10303 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
10304
10305 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target remote ...} and inspect memory
10306 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
10307 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
10308 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
10309
10310 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
10311 previously shown varibles.
10312
10313 @section RTOS Support
10314 @cindex RTOS Support
10315 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
10316
10317 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
10318 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
10319
10320 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
10321 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
10322 GDB commands.
10323
10324 @* An example setup is below:
10325
10326 @example
10327 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
10328 @end example
10329
10330 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
10331
10332 Currently supported rtos's include:
10333 @itemize @bullet
10334 @item @option{eCos}
10335 @item @option{ThreadX}
10336 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
10337 @item @option{linux}
10338 @item @option{ChibiOS}
10339 @item @option{embKernel}
10340 @item @option{mqx}
10341 @item @option{uCOS-III}
10342 @item @option{nuttx}
10343 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
10344 @end itemize
10345
10346 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
10347 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
10348
10349 @table @code
10350 @item eCos symbols
10351 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
10352 @item ThreadX symbols
10353 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
10354 @item FreeRTOS symbols
10355 @c The following is taken from recent texinfo to provide compatibility
10356 @c with ancient versions that do not support @raggedright
10357 @tex
10358 \begingroup
10359 \rightskip0pt plus2em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
10360 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
10361 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
10362 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
10363 \par
10364 \endgroup
10365 @end tex
10366 @item linux symbols
10367 init_task.
10368 @item ChibiOS symbols
10369 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
10370 @item embKernel symbols
10371 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
10372 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
10373 @item mqx symbols
10374 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
10375 @item uC/OS-III symbols
10376 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty
10377 @item nuttx symbols
10378 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable
10379 @end table
10380
10381 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
10382 some, eg. FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III, extra steps must be taken.
10383
10384 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
10385 along with the project:
10386
10387 @table @code
10388 @item FreeRTOS
10389 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
10390 @item uC/OS-III
10391 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
10392 @end table
10393
10394 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
10395 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
10396 @cindex SMP
10397 @cindex RTOS
10398 @cindex hwthread
10399 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
10400 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
10401 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
10402 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
10403 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
10404 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
10405 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
10406 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
10407 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
10408
10409 @section Legacy SMP core switching support
10410 @quotation Note
10411 This method is deprecated in favor of the @emph{hwthread} pseudo RTOS.
10412 @end quotation
10413
10414 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
10415 @itemize @bullet
10416 @item j - smp status request
10417 @item J - smp set request
10418 @end itemize
10419
10420 OpenOCD implements :
10421 @itemize @bullet
10422 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
10423 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
10424 @option{E01} for target not smp.
10425 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
10426 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
10427 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
10428 @end itemize
10429
10430 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
10431 @itemize @bullet
10432 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
10433 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
10434 @example
10435 set $_core 1
10436 #Jc01 packet is sent
10437 print $_core
10438 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
10439 @end example
10440
10441 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
10442 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
10443
10444 @example
10445 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
10446 define toggle0
10447 maint packet Jc0
10448 continue
10449 main packet Jc-1
10450 end
10451 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
10452 define toggle1
10453 maint packet Jc1
10454 continue
10455 main packet Jc-1
10456 end
10457 @end example
10458 @end itemize
10459
10460 @node Tcl Scripting API
10461 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
10462 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
10463 @cindex Tcl scripts
10464 @section API rules
10465
10466 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
10467 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
10468 of state information as an argument to each proc.
10469
10470 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
10471 pair list and lists.
10472
10473 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
10474 list.
10475
10476 @example
10477 > set foo(me) Duane
10478 > set foo(you) Oyvind
10479 > set foo(mouse) Micky
10480 > set foo(duck) Donald
10481 @end example
10482
10483 If one does this:
10484
10485 @example
10486 > set foo
10487 @end example
10488
10489 The result is:
10490
10491 @example
10492 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
10493 @end example
10494
10495 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
10496
10497 @verbatim
10498 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
10499 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
10500 }
10501 @end verbatim
10502
10503 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
10504 should be passed in to the proc in question.
10505
10506 @section Internal low-level Commands
10507
10508 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
10509 invoke directly.
10510
10511 @itemize @bullet
10512 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
10513
10514 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
10515 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
10516
10517 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
10518 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
10519
10520 Return information about the flash banks
10521
10522 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
10523
10524 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
10525 its execution. Example:
10526
10527 @example
10528 > capture "reset init"
10529 @end example
10530
10531 @end itemize
10532
10533 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
10534 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
10535 called "flash_banks".
10536
10537 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
10538
10539 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
10540 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
10541 holds one of the following values:
10542
10543 @itemize @bullet
10544 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
10545 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating system.
10546 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
10547 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
10548 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
10549 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating system
10550 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
10551 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
10552 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
10553 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
10554 @end itemize
10555
10556 Note: 'winxx' was chosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
10557
10558 @quotation Note
10559 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
10560 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
10561 @code{jim_platform} (because it
10562 is jim, not real tcl).
10563 @end quotation
10564
10565 @section Tcl RPC server
10566 @cindex RPC
10567
10568 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
10569 commands and receive the results.
10570
10571 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
10572 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
10573 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
10574 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
10575 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
10576
10577 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
10578 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
10579 @command{capture} command.
10580
10581 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
10582
10583 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
10584 @cindex RPC Notifications
10585
10586 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
10587 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
10588
10589 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
10590 in the following format.
10591
10592 @verbatim
10593 type target_event event [event-name]
10594 type target_state state [state-name]
10595 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
10596 @end verbatim
10597
10598 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
10599 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
10600 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
10601 Defaults to off.
10602
10603 @end deffn
10604
10605 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
10606 @cindex RPC trace output
10607
10608 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
10609 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
10610
10611 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
10612
10613 @verbatim
10614 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
10615 @end verbatim
10616
10617 @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
10618 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
10619 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
10620 Defaults to off.
10621
10622 See an example application here:
10623 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
10624
10625 @end deffn
10626
10627 @node FAQ
10628 @chapter FAQ
10629 @cindex faq
10630 @enumerate
10631 @anchor{faqrtck}
10632 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
10633 @cindex RTCK
10634 @cindex adaptive clocking
10635 @*
10636
10637 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
10638 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
10639 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
10640 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
10641
10642 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
10643 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
10644 for example. There are 2 basic options:
10645 @enumerate
10646 @item
10647 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
10648 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
10649 @item
10650 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
10651 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
10652 @end enumerate
10653
10654 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
10655 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
10656 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
10657 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
10658 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
10659 power).
10660
10661 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
10662 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
10663 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
10664 ARM926 scenario).
10665 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
10666 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
10667 JTAG can use a faster clock.
10668
10669 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
10670 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
10671 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
10672 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
10673
10674 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
10675
10676 In order to make use of this,
10677 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
10678 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
10679
10680 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
10681 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
10682 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
10683 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
10684 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
10685
10686 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
10687 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
10688 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
10689 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
10690
10691 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
10692 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
10693 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
10694 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
10695 with a CPLD.
10696 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
10697 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
10698 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
10699 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
10700 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
10701 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
10702
10703 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
10704
10705 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
10706
10707 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
10708 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
10709 depending on the chips on your board.
10710 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
10711 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
10712 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
10713
10714 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
10715 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
10716 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
10717
10718 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
10719 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
10720 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
10721 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
10722
10723 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
10724 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
10725 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
10726 this way.
10727
10728 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
10729 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
10730 clock rate.
10731 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
10732 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
10733 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
10734
10735 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
10736
10737 @example
10738 # Example: 1.234MHz
10739 adapter_khz 1234
10740 @end example
10741
10742
10743 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
10744
10745 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
10746 around Windows filenames.
10747
10748 @example
10749 > echo \a
10750
10751 > echo @{\a@}
10752 \a
10753 > echo "\a"
10754
10755 >
10756 @end example
10757
10758
10759 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
10760
10761 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
10762 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
10763 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
10764
10765 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
10766 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
10767 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
10768
10769 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
10770 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
10771 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
10772
10773 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
10774
10775 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
10776 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
10777 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
10778 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
10779
10780 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
10781 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
10782 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
10783
10784 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
10785 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
10786
10787 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
10788 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
10789 memory read caused data abort".
10790
10791 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
10792 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
10793 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
10794 be done, feel free to add this here.
10795
10796 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
10797 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
10798 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
10799 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
10800 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
10801 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
10802 gracefully stops.
10803
10804 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
10805 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
10806 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
10807
10808 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
10809 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
10810 bytes. Painful...
10811
10812
10813 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
10814 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
10815
10816 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
10817 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
10818 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
10819 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
10820 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
10821 reset, everything else should work fine.
10822
10823 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
10824 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
10825 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
10826 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
10827
10828 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
10829 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
10830 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
10831 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
10832
10833 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
10834
10835 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
10836 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
10837 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
10838
10839 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
10840 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
10841
10842 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
10843 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
10844 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
10845 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
10846 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
10847 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
10848 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
10849 clock frequency?
10850
10851 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
10852 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
10853 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
10854 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
10855 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
10856
10857 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
10858
10859 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
10860 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
10861 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
10862 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
10863 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
10864 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
10865 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
10866
10867 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
10868
10869 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
10870 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
10871 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
10872 up DRAM and loading it with code.
10873
10874 @anchor{faqtaporder}
10875 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
10876 particular order?
10877
10878 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
10879 the same order used by the hardware.
10880
10881 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
10882 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
10883 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
10884 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
10885 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
10886 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
10887
10888 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
10889 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
10890 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
10891 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
10892
10893 @itemize @bullet
10894 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
10895 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
10896 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
10897 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
10898 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
10899 @end itemize
10900
10901 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
10902
10903 @itemize @bullet
10904 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
10905 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
10906 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
10907 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
10908 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
10909 @end itemize
10910
10911
10912 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
10913 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
10914 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
10915
10916 TODO.
10917
10918 @end enumerate
10919
10920 @node Tcl Crash Course
10921 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
10922 @cindex Tcl
10923
10924 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
10925 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
10926 how the Tcl scripts work.
10927
10928 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
10929 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
10930 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
10931 OpenOCD.
10932
10933 @section Tcl Rule #1
10934 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
10935 @enumerate
10936 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
10937 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10938 @end enumerate
10939
10940 The Tcl equal is this:
10941
10942 @enumerate
10943 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
10944 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10945 @end enumerate
10946
10947 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
10948 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
10949
10950 @section Tcl Rule #1b
10951 There is a second pair of rules.
10952 @enumerate
10953 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
10954 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
10955 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
10956 in Tcl.
10957 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10958 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
10959 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
10960 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
10961 @end enumerate
10962
10963 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
10964 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
10965 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
10966 Everything is a string}
10967
10968 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
10969 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
10970 difference is subtle.
10971 @enumerate
10972 @item Parse Time
10973 @item Evaluation Time
10974 @end enumerate
10975
10976 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
10977 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
10978 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
10979
10980 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
10981 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
10982 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
10983 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
10984
10985 @itemize @bullet
10986 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
10987 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
10988 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
10989 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
10990 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
10991 @example
10992 # bash example
10993 X=`date`
10994 echo "The Date is: $X"
10995 # Tcl example
10996 set X [date]
10997 puts "The Date is: $X"
10998 @end example
10999 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
11000 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
11001 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
11002 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
11003 is a string}
11004 @example
11005 set x "Dinner"
11006 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
11007 @end example
11008 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
11009 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
11010 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
11011 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
11012 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
11013 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
11014 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
11015 @end itemize
11016
11017 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
11018
11019 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
11020
11021 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
11022
11023 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
11024 the normal way.
11025
11026 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
11027 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
11028 line is immediately executed.
11029
11030 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
11031 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
11032
11033 @subsection Command Execution
11034
11035 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
11036 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
11037 control flow operators.
11038
11039 Commands are executed like this:
11040
11041 @enumerate
11042 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
11043 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
11044 @item Repeat until End Of File.
11045 @end enumerate
11046
11047 It sort of works like this:
11048 @example
11049 for(;;)@{
11050 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
11051
11052 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
11053
11054 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
11055 @}
11056 @end example
11057
11058 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
11059 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
11060 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
11061 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
11062 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
11063 ``LookupCommand()''
11064
11065 @subsection The FOR command
11066
11067 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
11068 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
11069 command just like any other command.
11070
11071 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
11072 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
11073 are:
11074
11075 @enumerate 0
11076 @item The ascii text 'for'
11077 @item The start text
11078 @item The test expression
11079 @item The next text
11080 @item The body text
11081 @end enumerate
11082
11083 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
11084 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
11085 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
11086 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
11087
11088 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
11089 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
11090
11091 @example
11092 int
11093 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
11094 int *argc,
11095 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
11096 @end example
11097
11098 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
11099 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
11100 still operates in the same basic way.
11101
11102 @subsection FOR command implementation
11103
11104 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
11105 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
11106
11107 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
11108
11109 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
11110
11111 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
11112 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
11113 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
11114
11115 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
11116 expression and returns a value.
11117
11118 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
11119 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
11120 @example
11121 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
11122
11123 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
11124
11125 int
11126 MyForCommand( void *interp,
11127 int argc,
11128 char **argv )
11129 @{
11130 if( argc != 5 )@{
11131 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
11132 return ERROR;
11133 @}
11134
11135 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
11136
11137 // Execute the start statement.
11138 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
11139
11140 // Top of loop test
11141 for(;;)@{
11142 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
11143 if( i == 0 )
11144 break;
11145
11146 // Execute the body
11147 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
11148
11149 // Execute the LOOP part
11150 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
11151 @}
11152
11153 // Return no error
11154 SetResult( interp, "" );
11155 return SUCCESS;
11156 @}
11157 @end example
11158
11159 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
11160 in the same basic way.
11161
11162 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
11163
11164 @subsection source and find commands
11165 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
11166 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
11167 @*Remember the parsing rules
11168 @enumerate
11169 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
11170 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
11171 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
11172 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
11173 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
11174 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
11175 That character begins Tcl comments.)
11176 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
11177 it reads a file and executes as a script.
11178 @end enumerate
11179 @subsection format command
11180 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
11181 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
11182 @b{sprintf()}.
11183 @b{Example}
11184 @example
11185 set x 6
11186 set y 7
11187 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
11188 @end example
11189 @enumerate
11190 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
11191 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
11192 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
11193 @* Refer to Rule #1
11194 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
11195 @* Refer to Rule #1.
11196 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
11197 @end enumerate
11198 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
11199 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
11200 @example
11201 #1 Good
11202 proc someproc @{@} @{
11203 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
11204 @}
11205 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
11206 #2 Good - no variables
11207 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
11208 #3 Good Curly Braces
11209 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
11210 puts "Time: [date]"
11211 @}
11212 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
11213 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
11214 @end example
11215 @enumerate
11216 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
11217 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
11218 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
11219 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
11220 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
11221 command.
11222 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
11223 @*There are 4 examples:
11224 @enumerate
11225 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
11226 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
11227 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
11228 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
11229 @end enumerate
11230
11231 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
11232 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
11233 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
11234
11235 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
11236 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
11237 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
11238 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
11239 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
11240 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
11241 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
11242 @end enumerate
11243 @subsection Global Variables
11244 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
11245 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
11246 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
11247 @example
11248 proc myproc @{ @} @{
11249 set y 0 #Local variable Y
11250 global x #Global variable X
11251 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
11252 @}
11253 @end example
11254 @section Other Tcl Hacks
11255 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
11256 @example
11257 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
11258 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
11259 # Create var name
11260 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
11261 # Make it a global
11262 global $vn
11263 # Set it.
11264 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
11265 @}
11266 @end example
11267 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
11268 @example
11269 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
11270 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
11271 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
11272 @}
11273 @end example
11274
11275 @include fdl.texi
11276
11277 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
11278 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
11279 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
11280 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
11281 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
11282 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
11283
11284 @printindex cp
11285
11286 @node Command and Driver Index
11287 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
11288 @printindex fn
11289
11290 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)